S. 2205. A BILL TO ENACT THE OMNIBUS ANTIDRUG ABUSE ACT OF 1988, AND FOR OTHER PURPOSES; TO THE COMMITTEE ON THE JUDICIARY.

Document Type: 
Collection: 
Document Number (FOIA) /ESDN (CREST): 
CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1
Release Decision: 
RIFPUB
Original Classification: 
K
Document Page Count: 
44
Document Creation Date: 
December 27, 2016
Document Release Date: 
August 28, 2012
Sequence Number: 
5
Case Number: 
Publication Date: 
March 23, 1988
Content Type: 
MISC
File: 
AttachmentSize
PDF icon CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1.pdf7.87 MB
Body: 
Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE By Mr. BYRD: S. Res. 400. A resolution to modify section 5 of S. Res. 382, Ninetieth Congress; consid- ered and agreed to. STATEMENTS ON INTRODUCED BILLS AND JOINT RESOLUTIONS By Mr. DECONCINI (for him- self, Mr. D'AMATO, Mr. DIXON, Mr. MOYNIHAN, Mr. GRAHAM, Mr. DOMENICI, Mr. DOLE, Mr. WILSON, MS. MIKULSKI, Mr. KERRY, Mr. SPECTER, Mr. MUR- KOWSKI, Mr. ROCKEFELLER, Mr. BENTSEN, Mr. HATFIELD, Mr. PRESSLER, Mr. HEINZ, Mr. COCHRAN, Mr.. REID, Mr. HEFLIN, Mr. WEICKER, Mr. GRASSLEY, Mr. RUDMAN, Mr. STEVENS, Mr. INOUYE, Mr. TRIBLE, Mr. BINGAMAN, Mr. BREAUX, Mr. SARBANES, Mr. SANFORD, Mr. STENNIS, Mr. PELL, Mr. THURMOND, Mr. NICKLES, Mr. MCCONNELL, Mr. KARNES, Mr. DURENBERGER, Mr. HELMS, Mr. HECHT, and Mr. CRANSTON): S. 2205. A bill to enact the Omnibus Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988, and for other purposes; to the Committee on the Judiciary. OMNIBUS ANTIDRUG ABUSE ACT Mr. DECONCINI. Mr. President, I rise today to introduce the Omnibus Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988 and do so on behalf of myself, the distinguished Senator from New York, Senator D'AMATO and over 30 of my other col- leagues. Mr. President, the 1986 drug bill was an example of what this Chamber and what this Nation can do when it puts partisan politics aside, rolls up its col- lective sleeves, and gets serious about the drug problem in this country. Today, the bill that Senator D'AMATO and I are introducing builds on the ac- complishments of the 1986 drug bill and goes the next step in mobilizing all elements of our antidrug effort. Mr. President, there may be a part of the drug plague that we did not attack in this legislation-but there aren't many. This bill represents a bal- anced, comprehensive assault on the drug threat to this Nation. The bill calls for an additional $2,448,000,000, over the President's budget request for fiscal year 1989 to beef up: First, law enforcement personnel at our civilian drug enforcement agencies; second, drug interdiction assets for Coast Guard and Customs and other agen- cies with an interdiction mission; third, Federal prison construction; fourth, State and local narcotics con- trol assistance; fifth, international in- centives to promote drug eradication and interdiction at the drug source country level; sixth, treatment and re- habilitation assistance .for those who have already fallen victim to the drug menace; and seventh, drug education for our school systems around the Nation. The bill also opens up the Justice and Treasury Department forfeiture funds so that all of the resources re- sulting from seizure and confiscation from drug traffickers can be put to use for State and local law enforcement agencies and others who are eligible for such assistance. The bill includes a tough, new law that attacks the problem of illicit chemical diversion with rigid new pen- alties for those who use chemicals to manufacture the drugs that are poi- soning our youth and ruining lives in this country. The bill also authorizes funds for ad- ditional training of our law enforce- ment personnel and establishes a new program of research and development at existing Department of Defense and other Federal laboratories, to study new technologies that will help our drug enforcement agencies keep ahead of the sophisticated, well-financed drug smuggler. And, finally, the bill authorizes the establishment of a nonlegislative Senate Select Committee on Narcotics Abuse and Control that will give us a full-time oversight committee that will review the drug abuse issue and pro- vide advice and counsel to the Senate. Mr. President, in crafting this legis- lation, we knew that it would cost money to really launch a full scale as- sault on the drug problem on multiple fronts. We were aware of the economic budget summit agreement; the Gramm-Rudman-Hollings deficit tar- gets; and the need to try to find off- sets for the programs and initiatives contained in this legislation. So, Mr. President, this bill not only sets out new, aggressive initiatives for tackling the drug enforcement and drug abuse problems, it contains a for- mula for how we intend to pay for them.. Here is how we would pay for the bill: First, in testimony before my Treas- ury Appropriations Subcommittee just last Monday, the Commissioner of IRS testified that if we were to add $286.6 million and approximately 6,800 new positions over the President's budget, the Treasury would receive an addi- tional $1,120,000,000 over and above the revenue assumptions in the eco- nomic budget summit agreement. We would add the additional positions to IRS for increased tax enforcement and deposit the additional revenues generated into . a. special antidrug abuse trust fund in Treasury. These funds. would then only be available to pay for the drug bill. Second, in response to our inquiry, the Bureau of Alcohol, Tobacco, and Firearms indicated that an additional $3 million and 40 positions put into ag- gressive enforcement of the special oc- cupational alcohol tax would generate an additional $130 million over and above the President's budget for fiscal year 1989. We provide the additional funding and positions in this bill, with the additional revenues going into the new special fund I just mentioned. S 2857 Finally, for many years I have been introducing legislation that would force our Federal agencies to be more aggressive in the collection of delin- quent debt owed-to the Government. I was one of the original cosponsors of Senator CHARLES PERCY'S debt collec- tion bill back in 1980 and last year I introduced my own bill, S. 1270 that would provide new incentives and goals for debt collection. The bill that is being introduced today, mandates the collection of $2 billion over and above the debt collection estimates of the President for fiscal 1989. We include a new approach to push- ing agencies to use all of the tools available to collect the nearly $29 bil- lion in nontax delinquent debt cur- rently on the books. Under the bill, we would allow an agency to keep a por- tion of the funds it collects over and above its debt collection target set by the Secretary of the Treasury. On the other hand, if an agency falls short of . its target, the President would then propose a rescission of a portion of their funding, based on -how short of their goal they fell. All of the $2 billion to be collected over and above the President's budget estimates would be deposited into the special antidrug abuse Treasury fund to help pay for the drug bill. .In total, there would be more than enough additional revenues put into the special fund to cover the entire cost of the drug bill for fiscal year 1989, with some left over. So even if our estimates of the aggregate cost of the Omnibus Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988 are off slightly, the special fund would have sufficient resources to cover the bill's price tag. And we would not be violating either the Gramm-Rudman-Hollings targets, or the economic budget summit, or the President's budget. CONCLUSION Mr. President, this is a good bill. It hits the drug problem on many fronts. It is fiscally responsible and pays for itself. And, most importantly, it is needed now. The drug problem has not gone away since 1986. We need to provide this additional muscle to fight the narcotics trafficker-and this bill does that. Mr. President, I understand that Congressman GLENN ENGLISH will be introducing virtually the same bill later today in the House. I also under- stand that the Speaker of the House has made a commitment to Mr. ENG- LISH that he will attempt to bring up the drug bill before June. That is en- couraging, and I hope that the leader- ship in the Senate will move this legis- lation to the floor quickly before the summer. Mr. President, I ask unanimous con- sent that a copy of the Omnibus Anti- drug Abuse Act of 1988 be printed in the RECORD. Mr. President, I also ask unanimous consent that a detailed summary of Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2858 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE the bill and a cost breakdown of the bill be printed in the RECORD. There being no objection, the mate- rial was ordered to be printed in the RECORD, as follows: S.2205 Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the United States of America in Congress assembled, SECTION 1. SHORT TITLE. This Act may be cited as the "Omnibus Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988". SEC. 2. ORGANIZATION OF THE ACT. This Act is organized as follows: TITLE I-DRUG ENFORCEMENT AND PERSONNEL ENHANCEMENT SUBTITLE A. Asset Forfeiture Fund Amend- ments Act of 1988. SUBTITLE B. State and local narcotics con- trol assistance. SUBTITLE C. Chemical Diversion and Traf- ficking Act of 1988. SUBTITLE D. Comprehensive Federal Law Enforcement Officer Improve- ments Act of 1988. SUBTITLE E. Deportation of convicted for- eign drug inmates. SUBTITLE F. Customs Enforcement Amend- ments Act of 1988. SUBTITLE G. Authorization of additional ap- propriations for drug enforce- ment personnel, fiscal year 1989. SUBTITLE H. Miscellaneous law enforcement provisions. TITLE II-INTERNATIONAL NARCOT- ICS CONTROL AND ASSISTANCE TO FOREIGN COUNTRIES SUBTITLE A. International drug eradication improvement program. SUBTITLE B. International narcotics matters improvement and special as- sistance programs. SUBTITLE C. Amendments to Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961, as amended. SUBTITLE D. International narcotics matters authorization of appropria- tions. SUBTITLE E. Latin American Antidrug Strike Force. TITLE III-DRUG INTERDICTION ASSET IMPROVEMENT AND EN- HANCEMENT SUBTITLE A. Coast Guard. SUBTITLE B. United States Customs Service. SUBTITLE C. Department of Defense drug interdiction assistance. SUBTITLE D. Drug Enforcement Administra- tion. SUBTITLE E. Immigration and Naturalization Service/Border Patrol. SUBTITLE F. Establishment of Interagency Southwest Border Drug Inter- diction Mobile Corridor Task Force. SUBTITLE G. United States-Bahamas Drug Interdiction Task Force. SUBTITLE H. Special drug interdiction sup- port. TITLE IV-DEMAND REDUCTION SUBTITLE A. Treatment and rehabilitation. SUBTITLE B. Alcohol and drug abuse treat- ment and rehabilitation. SUBTITLE C. Amendments to the Drug-Free Schools and Communities Act. TITLE V-NATIONAL DRUG ENFORCE- MENT AGENCY REORGANIZATION AND COORDINATION SUBTITLE A. Establishment of Office of En- forcement and Border Affairs in Department of Treasury. SUBTITLE B. Department of Defense drug interdiction reorganization. SUBTITLE C. Establishment of a Senate Select Committee on Narcotics Abuse and Control. TITLE VI-RESEARCH AND DEVELOP- MENT FOR LAW ENFORCEMENT AGENCIES SUBTITLE A. Establishment of new research and development programs to assist Federal law enforcement agencies. SUBTITLE B. Cargo container drug detection research and development. TITLE VII-DRUG ENFORCEMENT TRAINING IMPROVEMENT SUBTITLE A. Federal Law Enforcement Training Center Improvement Act of 1988. SUBTITLE B. Department of Justice Training Facilities Improvement Act of 1988. SUBTITLE C. Federal Law Enforcement Lan- guage Training Improvement Act of 1988. SUBTITLE D. Authorization of appropriations for special training centers. TITLE VIII-DRUG TESTING IN THE PRIVATE SECTOR TITLE IX-CONGRESSIONAL POLICY REGARDING ADDITIONAL FUNDING FOR FISCAL YEAR 1989 FOR ANTI- DRUG ABUSE PROGRAMS TITLE X-FUNDING; ACCOUNTS SUBTITLE A. -Offsetting Revenues and Sav- ings to Cover the Cost of the Act. TITLE I-DRUG ENFORCEMENT AND PERSONNEL ENHANCEMENT Subtitle A-Asset Forfeiture Fund Amendments Act of 1988 SEC. 101. SHORT TITLE. This subtitle may be cited as the "Depart- ment of Justice and Department of Treas- ury Assets Forfeiture Fund Amendments Act of 1988". SEC. 102. ASSET FORFEITURE FUNDS. (a)(1) Notwithstanding any other provi- sion of law, the receipts and disbursements out of the Department of Justice Assets Forfeiture Fund, established by section 524(c)(1) of title 28, United States -Code, and the Customs Forfeiture Fund, established by section 613A of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1613b)- (A) shall not be included in the totals of- (i) the budget of the United States Gov- ernment as submitted by the President; or (ii) the congressional budget, including al- locations of budget authority and outlays provided therein; (B) shall be exempt from any general budget limitation imposed by statute on ex- penditures and net lending (budget outlays) of the United States Government; and (C) shall not be included for purposes of calculating- (i) the deficit under section 3(6) of the Congressional Budget and Impoundment Control Act of 1974 (2 U.S.C. 622(6)) for purposes of comparison with the maximum deficit amount under the Balanced Budget and Emergency Deficit Control Act of 1985 (2 U.S.C. 901 et seq.); or (ii) the excess deficit for purposes of sec- tions 251 and 252 of the Balanced Budget and Emergency Deficit Control Act of 1985 (2 U.S.C. 901 and 902) for any fiscal year. (2)(A) Notwithstanding any other provi- sion of law, for purposes of the Congression- al Budget and Impoundment Control Act of March 23, 1988 1974 (2 U.S.C. 621 et seq.) the Department of Justice, with respect to receipts and dis- bursements from the Assets Forfeiture Fund, and the United States Customs Serv- ice, with respect to receipts and disburse- ments from the Customs Forfeiture Fund, shall be considered an off-budget Federal entity as such entity is defined under sec- tion 3(8) of such Act (2 U.S.C. 622(8)). (B) Nothing in this subsection may be con- strued to diminish the oversight authority of the Congress under law with respect to the operations and budget of the Depart- ment of Justice or the United States Cus- toms Service. (C) Amounts to be disbursed out of the Department of Justice Assets Forfeiture Fund and the Customs Forfeiture Fund shall not be subject to limitation by appro- priations Acts. (D) This subsection shall apply to budgets for fiscal years beginning after September 30, 1988. (3) Section 613A of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1613b) is amended by- (A) striking out "subject to appropriation, during the period beginning on the date of the enactment of this section and ending on September 30, 1991. The fund shall be avail- able" in subsection (a); and (B) striking out "during the period begin- ning on the date of the enactment of this section, and ending on September 30, 1987," in subsection (c); and - (C) repealing subsection (f). (b) Section 524(c)(l) of title 28 of the United States Code is amended by striking out "and" at the end of subparagraph (F), by striking out the period at the end of sub- paragraph (G) and inserting in lieu thereof "; and" and, by inserting the following new subparagraph: "(H) after all reimbursements and pro- gram-related expenses have been met at the end of each fiscal year, the Attorney Gener- al shall transfer deposits from the Assets Forfeiture Fund to the Building and Facili- ties account of the Federal prison system for the construction of correctional institu- tions, and to the Support of United States Prisoners in non-Federal Institutions ac- count of the Department of Justice for pay- ments authorized by the Attorney General or his designee under contracts and coopera- tive agreements with any State, territory, or political subdivision thereof, for the neces- sary construction, physical renovation, ac- quisition of equipment, supplies, or materi- als required to establish acceptable condi- tions of confinement and detention services in any State or local jurisdiction which agrees to provide guaranteed bedspace for Federal detainees within that correctional system. The Attorney General shall report to the appropriate committees of the Con- gress any amount proposed to be trans- ferred under this subparagraph.". (c) Amounts proposed for transfer pursu- ant to subsection (a) shall be transferred only upon notification by the Attorney Gen- eral to the Committees on Appropriations of the House of Representatives and the Senate and approval under said Commit- tees' policies concerning the reprogramming of funds. (d)(1) Section 524(c)(1)(A) of title 28, United States Code, is amended by inserting immediately before the semicolon at the end thereof a comma and the following: "and the Attorney General may exempt the procurement of supplies and services under the fund from section 3709 of the Revised Statutes of the United States (41 U.S.C. 5), title III of the Federal Property and Admin- istrative Services Act of 1949 (41 U.S.C. 251 and following), and other provisions of law as may be necessary to maintain the securi- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE ty and confidentiality of related criminal or civil investigations". (2) In the administration of the Customs Forfeiture Fund, the Commissioner of Cus- toms may exempt the procurement of sup- plies and services under such Customs Fund from section 3709 of the Revised Statutes of the United States (41 U.S.C. 5), title III of the Federal Property and Administrative Services Act of 1949 (41 U.S.C. 251), and other provisions of law as may be necessary to maintain the security and confidentiality of related criminal or civil investigations. SEC. 103. RESTORATION OF EQUITABLE SHARING PROVISIONS. Section 511(e) of the Controlled Sub- stances Act (21 U.S.C. 881(e)) is amended by- (1) redesignating paragraph (2) as'para- graph (3); and (2) inserting after paragraph (1) the fol- lowing new paragraph: "(2) The Attorney General shall ensure the equitable transfer pursuant to para- graph (1)(A) of any forfeited property to the appropriate State and local law enforce- ment agency or prosecutor's office so as to reflect generally the contribution of any such agency or prosecutor's office partici- pating directly in any of the acts which led to the seizure or forfeiture of such property or prosecution of any underlying criminal case or forfeiture action.". Subtitle B--State and Local Narcotics Control Assistance Act of 1988 SEC. 110. DECLARATION AND PURPOSE. (a) Congress finds that this Nation is en- gulfed in an epidemic of drug abuse that is threatening our country's productivity and, in particular, the minds and future of our youngest citizens. Throughout the past decade, trends in trafficking and abuse pat- terns have necessitated a new response-one that is the product of a nationwide strategy that is not limited by jurisdictional bound- aries and single constituency interests. The absence of legislatively mandated or policy driven targeting of resources and energy will sustain a scattered approach to a drug abuse problem which, by its nature, de- mands a concerted, coordinated attack. (b) Congress further finds that State and local governments are critical participants in a national effort to reduce the demand for and stem the distribution of drugs in this Nation. (c) It is therefore the declared policy of the Congress to initiate a new national strategy to curb drug abuse in the United States that makes full use of the energy and expertise of State and local units of govern- ment. (d) It is the,purpose of this subtitle to em- power States to address their own jurisdic- tional drug control problems while, simulta- neously, supporting national drug control priorities and objectives. Congress finds that enhanced national attention, and thus resources provided under this subtitle, are required In the areas of (1) generation and linkage of intelligence information and sys- tems; (2) coordination of effort at the Fed- eral, State, and local levels of government; (3) model legislation enacted on a nation- wide basis; (4) strategic drug control plan- ning and policy that integrates education, prevention, treatment, enforcement, pros- ecution, and corrections in a systemwide ap- proach; (5) standardization of data collec- tion systems; and (6) technological and operational advancements. PART A-ESTABLISHMENT OF THE BUREAU OF JUSTICE ASSISTANCE SEC. 111. BUREAU OF JUSTICE ASSISTANCE. Section 401 of part D of title I of the Om- nibus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968 (42 U.S.C. 3741) is amended to read as follows: "There is established within the Depart- ment of Justice, under the general author- ity of the Attorney General, a Bureau of Justice Assistance (hereinafter referred to in this part and part D as the "Bureau"). The Bureau shall be headed by a Director (hereinafter referred to as the "Director") who shall be appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate. The Director shall have final au- thority for all grants, cooperative agree- ments, and contracts awarded by the Bureau. The Director shall not engage in any employment other than that of serving as the Director, nor shall the Director hold any office in, or act in any capacity for, any organization, agency, or institution with which the Bureau makes any contract or other arrangement under this or such SEC. 112. DUTIES AND FUNCTIONS OF THE DIREC- TOR. The Director of the Bureau of Justice As- sistance (hereinafter in this subtitle re- ferred to in this title as the "Director"), in addition to his duties under part D of title I of the Omnibus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968, shall- (1) provide funds to eligible States, units of local government, and private nonprofit and public organizations pursuant to this subtitle; (2) after consultation with Federal, State, and local drug control agencies, develop an annual State and Local Strategic Drug Con- trol Plan that integrates priorities and criti- cal needs of Federal, State, and local drug control; and (3) publish and disseminate information on the condition and progress of drug con- trol activities at the Federal, State, and local levels, with particular attention to pro- grams and intervention efforts demonstrat- ed by assessments to be of value in an over- all national strategy. SEC. 113. STATE AND LOCAL COORDINATION. To assure that all Federal assistance to State and local drug control programs is car- ried out in an efficient manner, the Bureau of Justice Assistance (hereinafter referred to in this title as the "Bureau") is author- ized to coordinate activities and request any Federal department or agency to supply such statistics, program reports, and other material as the Bureau deems necessary to carry out its, functions under this subtitle. Each such department or agency is author- ized and directed to cooperate with the Bureau and, to the extent permitted by law, to furnish such materials to the Bureau. The Bureau shall- (1) ensure a fully coordinated effort toward a national drug control strategy in- volving drug control departments, agencies, and boards at the Federal, State, and local levels of government; (2) serve as the coordinating Federal agency for the submission of a single appli- cation for all State and local grant-in-aid programs under the Antidrug Abuse Act of 1986; coordinate the application require- ments with each of the Federal agencies in- volved to allow for one State document that represents a statewide drug control strategy incorporating all drug control elements (e.g., prevention, education, enforcement, treatment). Such single State submission is intended to meet the requirements of the Departments of Education, Health and Human Services, Justice, and any other Federal agencies providing financial or tech- nical assistance and intergovernmental fiscal transfers; and (3) consider the priorities of and maintain liaison with Federal agencies having drug S 2859 control authority to assure a coordinated placement and implementation of major programs to the initiated. PART B-DRUG CONTROL FORMULA GRANT PROGRAM SEC. 114. GRANTS. It is the purpose of this part to encourage the implementation of a nationwide and multilevel drug control strategy through the development of programs and projects which will assist multijurisdictional and multi-State in the drug control problem and support national drug control priorities. It is not the intent of Congress to restrict the use of programs at the State and local level, but to encourage a systematic approach to a national strategy which will involve all par- ticipants working toward a similar- goal. Grants may be made for additional person- nel, equipment, facilities, personnel train- ing, and supplies. The Bureau is authorized to make grants to States having statewide drug control strategies approved by the Bureau for: (1) Zero Tolerance Enforcement Programs that effect heightened public awareness of and support for local drug control enforce- ment projects such as drug specific - (e.g., gang targeted, organized crime) task forces, street sweeps, and special projects for high visibility crime areas. (2) Multi-Jurisdictional Task Force Pro- grams that integrate the resources and knowledge of Federal, State, and local drug law enforcement agencies for the purpose of enhancing interagency coordination and fa- cilitating multijurisdictional investigations. (3) Precursor Control Programs designed to prevent major precursor chemicals from reaching clandestine laboratories, including recordkeeping systems, monitoring proce- dures, and model legislation such as that en- acted by the States of Arizona, California, Nevada, and Texas. (4) Pharmaceutical Diversion Programs di- rected at the licensing, regulation, and in- vestigation of practitioners registrants, in- cluding Schedule 2 triplicate prescription programs and enactment of model legisla- tion. (5) Law Enforcement Demand Reduction Programs that increase the participation of drug law enforcement officers in drug abuse prevention programs, such as the Law En- forcement Explorers Program, Sport Drug Awareness Program, and Drug Abuse Re- sistance Education (DARE). (6) Countermeasures Threat Analysis Pro- grams that address the technological capa- bilities of drug traffickers, the threat that such technology poses to the safety and ef- fectiveness of drug law enforcement offi- cers, and responses to the threat, including nationwide threat assessments, and technol- ogy development projects. (7) Clandestine Laboratory Programs that enhance the investigative capabilities of State and local officers, and provide certi- fied training and equipment necessary to ensure the safety of State and local person- nel who seize and enter clandestine labora- tories. . (8) Drug Control Law Enforcement Train- ing Programs that enhance the technical ca- pabilities of State and local drug control personnel. (9) Multi-Jurisdictional Intelligence and Data Sharing Programs designed to effect the linkage of regional intelligence systems, standardize data reporting systems, and in- crease multijurisdictional access to nation- wide data bases. (10) Domestic Cannabis Programs that target major financiers, cultivators, and dis- tributors, and that provide the resources Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2860 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE March 23, 1988 and training that are essential for effective technical expertise of judicial personnel in tions and State agencies and establishing State and local eradication efforts. drug control cases. Statewide drug control priorities based on (11) Financial Investigative Programs that (22) Pre-Trial Drug Control Testing Pro- such; target the identification of money launder- grams that provide urinalysis testing as a (2) preparing a statewide drug control ing operations and assets obtained through pretrial device for providing drug-use data strategy reflecting the state's drug control illegal drug trafficking, including the enact- to courts. Projects can provide jail space by problems, an assessment of current activi- ment of model legislation, financial investi- continued monitoring of nondetained indi- ties, coordination requirements, resource gative training, and financial information viduals. needs, and the statewide goals, objectives, sharing systems. (23) Drug Control -Innovative Adjudica- priorities, and projected programs and (12) Drug Control Innovative Enforce- tion Programs which will demonstrate new projects; ment Programs which will demonstrate new and different approaches to drug control ac- (3) receiving, reviewing, and approving (or and different approaches to drug control ac- tivities. Each project shall contain an eval- disapproving) applications from State agen- tivities. Each project shall contain an eval- uation component and the results of such cies and units of local government; uation component and the results of such will be provided to the Bureau. Up to 10 per (4) preparing an annual report for the will be provided to the Bureau. Up to 10 per centum of the total judicial projects award- chief executive of the State and the State centum of the total enforcement projects ed may be used for this program. legislature containing an assessment of the may be used for this program. (24) Intensive Supervision Programs State drug control program developed under (13) Model Drug Control Legislation Pro- which reduce drug use and criminal activi- this part, for submission to the Bureau; and grams that encourage State adoption of ties through intensive probation. Project (5) assuring fund accountability, auditing, model legislation in areas such as money elements may include surveillance, urinaly- and evaluation of programs and projects laundering, activities under chapter 96 of sis, and treatment standards. Treatment Al- funded under this part to assure compliance title 18, United States Code, electronic sur- ternatives to Street Crime projects may be with Federal requirements. veillance, asset seizure and forfeiture, grand funded under this program. jury powers, schoolyard violators, criminal (25) Jail Treatment Programs which iden- SEC. 117. MEMBERSHIP OF THE STATE DRUG CON- organization use of juveniles, mandatory tify drug abusing offenders and initiate ap- TROL BOARDS. and enhanced sentencing. propriate treatment while incarcerated (pre- The State Drug Control Board shall be (14) Drug Control Prosecution Training and post-trial), and coordinate with commu- subject to the jurisdiction of the chief exec- Programs to develop and conduct training nity treatment providers for inmates upon utive of the State who shall appoint the projects designed to enhance prosecutorial release. board members, designate a chairman and expertise in the prosecution of complex (26) Prison Treatment Programs which provide staff to serve the board. The board drug conspiracy cases, including search war- provide a continuum of treatment services should be broadly representative of the rant preparation, asset seizure and forfeit- to the drug dependent offender. Projects State's drug control community, with repre- ure (for both prosecutors and investigators), may include a range of treatment modalities sentatives from disciplines such as drug en- grand jury presentations, case preparation such as therapeutic communities, drug re- forcement, prosecution, courts, corrections, and presentation, and electronic surveil- source centers, drug education projects, and treatment, education, and prevention, in- lance utilization. self-help groups. eluding private treatment providers. (15) For use in States that have the au- (27) Drug Treatment for Youthful Of- SEC. 118. LOCAL DRUG CONTROL OFFICES. thority to undertake prosecutions but lack fenders Programs which address the needs The State drug control office shall assure the necessary resources to initiate activities of the youthful offenders. Projects may in- that local units of government for metropol- under those statutes, Combined Prosecution clude special intensive efforts or projects itan areas (primary metropolitan statistical and Law Enforcement Investigative Pro- conducted in coordination with educational areas as defined by the Bureau of the grams to develop enforcement and prosecu- institutions. Census) or any contiguous combination of Lion projects to assist State and local law en- (28) State Corrections Policy Groups and such (both interstate and intrastate), forcement agencies to use existing State Sentencing Commissions dealing with long- having a population of 500,000 or more, are laws specifically targeted toward narcotics range State corrections strategies and na- permitted to establish a local office for the trafficking conspiracies and offenders. tional sentencing structures for both drug purpose of preparing and coordinating drug (16) Corrupt Public Officials Programs that give priority attention to related and other crimes. control strategies and implementing the any case in- (29) Enhancement of Indicator Systems provisions of this part at the local level of volving drug-related official corruption. Programs which collect and disseminate government. The chief executive of an eligi- This program is consistent with the zero-tol- data regarding drug use, availability, and ble jurisdiction as defined above shall create erance approach drug control and can en- hance public confidence other drug trend information vital to the ef- or designate an office for the purpose of w mn support hance for drug control thereby law enforcement fective planning and intelligence. This may preparing and developing an areawide drug efforts. include criminal history and transactional control strategy and assuring that such (17) State and Local information systems. strategy complies with the Federal and tha enhance existing forensic story Loro laboratories Programs (30) Statewide and National Intelligence State requirements, to include fund ac- through the use of se of additional personnel, Systems Programs which collect, dissemi- counting, auditing, and evaluation of pro- uip thning,al and supplies. nate, and use investigative or intelligence in- grams and projects to be funded under this Prd, Projects will will standardize facilities, training, reporting drug con- formation for drug control enforcement ac- part. Where an eligible jurisdiction chooses trol data and intelligence information on a tivities. Emphasis of these projects shall be not to form a local drug control office, it nationwide basis as well as reports to pros- the sharing of information at Federal, shall be treated as all other jurisdictions ecutors, thus reducing the court time for State, and local levels of government. within the State. laboratory personnel. (31) Drug Control Evaluation Programs SEC. 119. LOCAL DRUG CONTROL BOARDS. (18) Prosecutor Resource Enhancement which the State and local units of govern- Each eligible jurisdiction shall establish or Programs that enhance existing prosecutor merit may utilize to evaluate programs and designate a local drug control board for the services resulting from an expanded case- projects directed at State drug control ac- purpose of- load of drug control cases. Projects will im- tivities. (1) analyzing the drug control problems prove case management through the use of SEC. 115. STATE DRUG CONTROL OFFICES. within the jurisdiction based on data, Infor- additional personnel (e.g., prosecutors, in- The chief executive officer of each partici- mation, and intelligence from all eligible vestigators), management information sys- Dating State and territory shall designate a units of local government and establishing tems, and programs such as career criminal State drug control office for the purpose jurisdictionwide drug control priorities targeting, and accelerated prosecutions. of- based on such; (19) Drug Control Innovative Prosecution (1) preparing an application to obtain (2) preparing a jurisdictionwide drug con- Programs which will demonstrate new and funds under this part; and trol strategy reflecting the jurisdiction's different approaches to drug control activi- (2) administering funds received from the drug control problems, an assessment of ties. Each project shall contain an evalua. Bureau, including receipt, review, process- current activities, coordination require- tion component and the results of such will ing, monitoring, progress, and impact re- ments, resource needs, and the jurisdiction's be provided to the Bureau. Up to 10 per porting, financial report review, technical goals, objectives, priorities, and projected centum of the total prosecution projects assistance, grant adjustments, accounting, programs and projects; awarded may be used for this program, auditing, and funds disbursements. (3) receiving, reviewing, and approving (or (20) Judicial Resource Enhancement Pro- SEC. 116. STATE DRUG CONTROL BOARDS. disapproving) applications from units of grams that enhance existing court resources The chief executive officer of each partici- local government; and resulting from an expanded caseload of pating State and territory shall establish or (4) preparing an annual report for the drug control cases. Projects may include ad- designate and maintain a State Drug Con- chief executive of the jurisdiction and the ditional judges and supporting staff, equip- trol Board for the purpose of- State office (or offices in the case of metro- ment, and facilities. (1) analyzing the drug control problems politan areas or State boundaries) contain- (21) Judicial Drug Control Training Pro- within the State based on data, information, ing an assessment of the drug control pro- grams that are designed to enhance the and intelligence from all eligible jurisdic- gram developed under this part. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2861 SEC. 120. MEMBERSHIP OF LOCAL DRUG CONTROL BOARDS. (a) The Local Drug Control Board shall be subject to the jurisdiction of the chief exec- utive who shall appoint the members and designate the chairman. The Board shall be representative of the drug control communi- ty, with representatives from disciplines such as drug enforcement, prosecution, courts, corrections, treatment, education and prevention, including private treatment providers. (b) In the case of an eligible jurisdiction being formed by a combination of jurisdic- tions, the membership of the Board shall be jointly appointed in such a manner as the chief executive of each unit of local govern- ment shall determine by mutual agreement. Decisions made by the Board pursuant to this part may be reviewed and either accept- ed or rejected by the chief executive of the jurisdiction, or a combination of jurisdic- tions in such a manner as the chief execu- tive of each unit of local government shall determine by mutual agreement. SEC. 121. NATIONAL DRUG CONTROL ASSISTANCE COORDINATION BOARD. The Bureau shall establish a National Drug Control Assistance Coordination Board, which will provide for the represen- tation of drug control agencies at the Feder- al, State, and local levels for the purpose of articulating national drug control priorities, programs, and resource needs. The Bureau is directed to prepare a National Strategic Drug Control Plan which will target critical drug control problems and lead to a Nation- al Drug Control Strategy that will integrate Federal, State, and local drug control prior- ities. SEC. 122. BOARD MEMBERSHIP. (a) The Board shall consist of twenty members representing State and Federal agencies having responsibilities for drug control activities. Each of the five national regions would appoint two representatives to the Board and the appropriate Federal agencies would appoint the remaining ten members. The ten Federal appointees shall be approved by the Attorney General. The Director will serve as the Board Chair. (b) The Bureau shall develop all rules and procedures, provide staff services and the fi- nancial resources required by the Board. SEC. 123. STATE APPLICATION. (a) To request funds under this part, the chief executive officer of the State shall submit to the Bureau an application, at such time and in such form as the Director may require. No State application shall be approved unless it includes- (1) a statewide strategy for drug control. The strategy must contain (A) a definition and analysis of the drug problem in the State, and an analysis of that problem in each of the major cities and counties with major drug control problems; (B) an assess- ment of the efforts existing as of the time of the application to address the drug con- trol problem at the State and local level; (C) coordination requirements; (D) resource needs; (E) the establishment of Statewide priorities for drug control activities and pro- grams; and (F) an analysis of the relation- ship of the proposed State efforts to the na- tional drug control strategy; (2) the following certifications and assur- ances signed by the chief executive or his authorized representative: (A), a certification that Federal funds made available under this part will not be used to supplant State or local funds, but will be used to increase the amounts of such funds that would, in the absence of Federal funds, be made, available for drug law en- forcement activities; (B) a certification that funds required to pay the non-Federal portion of the costs of each program and project for which such grant is made shall be in addition to funds that would otherwise be made available for drug law enforcement by the recipients of grant funds; (C) an assurance that the State applica- tion described in this part, and any amend- ment to such application, has been submit- ted for review to the State legislature or its designated body (for purposes of this part, such application or amendment shall be deemed to be reviewed if the State legisla- ture or such body does not review such ap- plication or amendment within the 60-day period beginning on the date such applica- tion or amendment is so submitted); (D) an assurance that the State applica- tion and any amendment thereto was made public before submission to the Bureau and, to the extent provided under State law or established procedure, an opportunity to comment thereon was provided to citizens and to neighborhood community groups; and (E) an assurance that following the first fiscal year covered by an application and for each fiscal year thereafter, a performance evaluation and assessment report concern- ing the activities carried out pursuant to this part will be submitted to the Bureau; and (3) a provision for fund accounting, audit- ing, monitoring, and such evaluation proce- dures as may be necessary to keep such records that the Bureau shall prescribe to assure fiscal control, proper management, and efficient disbursement of funds received under this part. (b) The data requirements on which the statewide strategy is based shall be devel- oped by the Bureau and provided to each State for the purpose of assuring a unified national data reporting system. SEC. 124. GRANT LIMITATIONS. (a) Not more than 20 per centum of a grant made under this part may be used for costs incurred to administer such grant by the State and local offices. The State is au- thorized to use up to 10 per centum as ad- ministrative funds and the local offices are authorized to use up to 10 per centum as ad- ministrative funds. If not used for adminis- trative purposes at the local level, such funds must be used for the purpose con- tained in part B. (b) States are authorized to use. part B funds for the expenses associated with par- ticipation in the State and Local Task Force Program established by the Drug Enforce- ment Administration. (c) The State shall provide to metropoli- tan area(s), of the pass-through formula, a per centum not less than the per centum which the population (500,000 or more) is to the total population of the State. (d) The State shall make available such funds to eligible metropolitan area(s) within 30 days after the Bureau's approval of the State application: SEC. 125. MATCHING FUNDS. (a) The non-Federal portion of the cost of the programs or projects authorized by part B of this subtitle shall be in cash. (b) Any Federal grant made under this part shall cover up to 100 percent of the cost of the programs and projects author- ized by this part for the first year in which a grant is approved; up to 90 percent of the cost of the. programs and projects author- ized by this part for the second year of such grant; and up to 75 percent of the cost of the programs and projects. authorized by this part for the third year of such grant. SEC. 126. REVIEW OF STATE APPLICATIONS. (a) The Bureau shall provide financial as- sistance to each State applicant under this part to carry out the programs or projects submitted by such applicant upon determin- ing that- (1) the application and amendment there- to is consistent with the requirements of this part; (2) the statewide strategy is in accordance with the Bureau's guidelines, representative of statewide priorities and the priorities of all eligible jurisdictions, represents a sincere attempt on the part of the applicant to con- trol drug trafficking and abuse and clearly represents an interest by the applicant to cooperate with other States and jurisdic- tions relative to drug control; and (3) the application and any amendment have been reviewed in accordance with this part and that an affirmative finding has been made, in writing, that the application, strategy, and programs and projects are rep- resentative of the broad priorities and re- source needs of the State and eligible juris-. dictions encompassed by the strategy. (b) Each application or amendment made and submitted for approval to the Bureau pursuant to this part shall be deemed ap- proved, in whole or in part, by the Bureau not later than 60 days after first received, unless the Bureau informs the applicant of specific reasons for disapproval prior to the expiration of such 60-day period. (c) Grant funds awarded under this part shall not be used for land acquisition or con- struction projects. (d) The Bureau shall not finally disap= prove any application, or any amendment thereto, submitted to the Bureau under this part without first affording the applicant reasonable notice and opportunity for re- consideration., SEC. 127. ALLOCATION AND DISTRIBUTION OF FUNDS UNDER FORMULA GRANTS. (a) Of the total amount appropriated for this part in any fiscal year, 80 per centum shall be set aside for the formula grant pro- gram and allocated to States as follows: (1) $500,000 shall be allocated to each of the participating States and territories; and (2) of the total funds remaining after the allocation under the above paragraph (1), there shall be allocated to each State an amount which bears the same ratio to the amount of remaining funds described in this paragraph as the population of such States bears to the population of all the States. (b)(1) Each State which receives funds under subsection (a) of this section in a fiscal year shall distribute among units of local government, or combinations of units of local government, in such States, for the purposes specified in the formula grant pro- gram, that portion of funds which bears the same ratio to the aggregate amount of such funds as the amount of funds expended by all units of local government for criminal justice in the preceding fiscal year bears to the aggregate amount of funds expended by the State and all units of local government in such State for criminal justice in such preceding fiscal year. (2) Any funds not distributed to units of local government under paragraph (b)(1) shall be available for expenditure by the State involved. (3) For purposes of determining the distri- bution of funds under paragraph (1), the most accurate and complete data available for the fiscal year involved shall be used. If data for such fiscal year is not available, then the most accurate and complete data available for the most recent fiscal year pre- ceding such fiscal year shall be used. (c) No funds allocated to a State under subsection (a) or received by a State"for dis- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 5.2862 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD--SENATE tribution under subsection (b) may be dis- tributed by the Bureau or by the State in- volved for any program other .than a pro- gram contained in an application. (d) If the Bureau determines, on the basis of information available to it during any fiscal year, that a portion of the funds allo- cated to a State for that fiscal year will not be required or that a State will be unable to qualify or receive funds under the formula grant program, or that a State chooses not to participate in the program established under such section, then such portion shall be awarded by the Bureau to urban, rural, and suburban units of local government or combinations thereof within such State giving priority to those jurisdictions with greatest need. (e) Any funds allocated under subsection (a) that are not distributed under this sec- tion shall be available for obligation. under part C of this subtitle. PART C-DRUG CONTROL DISCRETIONARY GRANT PROGRAM SEC. 128. PURPOSE. It is the purpose of this part to provide for the direct funding of projects to improve and strengthen the drug control and related criminal justice support activities at the State and local levels. SEC. 129. PURPOSE OF GRANTS. The Bureau is authorized to develop pro- grams and make grants to public agencies and private nonprofit organizations for technical assistance, training, national scope and demonstration projects in support of any of the.purposes (or groups of purposes) specified in part B of this subtitle, and any purpose contained in the strategic drug con- trol plan developed by. the Bureau. The Di- rector shall have final authority over all grants awarded under this part. In develop- ing Discretionary Grant programs, the Bureau shall insure a balance between the various components of the criminal justice system and drug treatment and rehabilita- tion agencies. Discretionary funds may be used as incentives to develop programs -in the weaker elements of the statewide drug control strategies. Because of the crisis facing State and local corrections, the Di- rector shall insure adequate attention to this component, as well as support for cor- rections-based drug treatment and rehabili- tation programs. SEC. 129A. GRANTS. (a) A grant authorized under this part may be up to 100 per centum of the total cost of each project for which the grant is made. (b) Grant funds awarded under this part shall not be used for land acquisition or con- struction projects. SEC. 129B. APPLICATION REQUIREMENTS. (a) No grant may be made under this part unless an application has been submitted to the Bureau in which the applicant- (1) sets forth a program or project which is eligible for funding pursuant to this sub- title; - (2) describes the services to be provided, performance goals, and the manner in which the program is to be carried out; and (3) describes the method to be used to evaluate-the program or project in order to determine its impact and effectiveness in achieving the stated goals; and (4) agrees to conduct such evaluation ac- cording to the procedures and terms estab- lished by the Bureau. (b) Each applicant for funds under this part shall certify, in a form acceptable to the Director, that- (1) the program or project meets all the requirements of this part; (2) all of the information contained in the application is correct; and (3) the applicant will comply with all of the provisions of this part and all other ap- plicable Federal laws. SEC. 130. ALLOCATION OF FUNDS FOR DISCRETION- ARY GRANTS. (a) Of the total amount appropriated for this subtitle in any fiscal year, 20 per centum shall be reserved and set aside for this part. (b) Of the total amount appropriated for this subtitle in any fiscal year, 20 per centum shall be made available to metropol- itan areas and consolidated jurisdictions of populations in excess of 500,000 for the pur- pose of assisting the State in providing a comprehensive drug control program in an area determined to have an extensive drug control problem. , (c) Each State shall indicate the need for such funds through the submission of the State strategy and application. The Bureau will evaluate the strategy to determine those major cities with the most critical drug control problems, including the re- sources to" be committed by the State and local units of government, and the planned activities for drug control. After site selec- tions are made, the Bureau shall request formal applications. (d) Of the total amount appropriated for this part in any fiscal year, 5 per centum shall be made available for the purpose of evaluation of programs and projects con- tained in this subtitle. SEC. 131. PERIOD OF AWARD. The Bureau may provide financial aid and assistance to programs and projects under this part for a period not to exceed 3 years. Grants made pursuant to this part may be extended or renewed by,the Bureau for an additional period of up to 2 years if- (1) an evaluation of the program or project indicates that it has been effective in achieving the stated goals and offers the potential for improving the drug control problem; and (2) the State, unit of local government, or combination thereof and private nonprofit organizations within which the program or project has been conducted agrees to pro- vide at least one-half of the total cost of such program or project from formula grant funds or from any other source of funds. PART D-TARGETED STATE AND LOCAL STRATEGIC DRUG CONTROL PLAN SEC. 132..LOCAL PRIORITIES AND PROGRAMS. It is the intent of this part to establish an ongoing process for integrating Federal, State, and local priorities and programs. SEC. 133. PLAN. (a) The Bureau is directed to complete an annual National Strategic Drug Control Plan which targets the most critical drug control problems that are most effectively resolved at the State and local levels. (b) Such plan shall be developed by the Bureau in consultation with the State Drug Control Boards and those Federal agencies and boards authorized to engage in drug control, programs including, but not limited to, the Federal Bureau of Investigation, Drug Enforcement Administration, U.S. Customs, Department of the Treasury, De- partment of Defense, Department of Educa- tion, Department of Health and Human Re- sources, and the Department of Justice and agencies thereof. (c) Each annual plan shall include an as- sessment of the current drug control prob- lem, emerging trends, critical response areas, resource assessment, coordination re- quirements, and objectives for the next fiscal year. (d) Such plan shall effect the coordination of resources and strategies at the Federal, State, and local levels culminating in a March 23, 1988 "blueprint" for action involving the Con- gress, the Executive Branch, and Federal drug control agencies in total cooperation with units of State and local government. PART E-MISCELLANEOUS AMENDMENTS TO JUSTICE ASSISTANCE ACT OF 1984 SEC. 133A. AMENDMENTS TO 42 U.S.C. 3769 CRIMINAL. JUSTICE _ FACILITY CONSTRUCTION PILOT PROGRAM. (a) The heading for part F of title I of the Omnibus Crime Control and Safe .Streets Act of 1968 (42 U.S.C. 3701-3799) is amend- ed by deleting "Pilot". (b) Section 602(a)(1) of part F of - such Act (42 U.S.C. 3769a) is amended by deleting ", with the concurrence of the Director of the National Institute of Corrections estab- lished in chapter 315 of title 18, United States Code,". (c) Section 603(b)(1)(B) of.part F of such Act (42 U.S.C. 3769b) is amended by deleting "20" and inserting in lieu thereof "80". (d) Section 603(c) of part F of such Act (42 U.S.C. 3769b) is amended by deleting "20" and inserting in lieu thereof "80". PART F-ADMINISTRATIVE PROVISIONS SEC 134.. RULES; REGULATIONS. The Bureau is authorized to establish such rules, regulations, and procedures as may be necessary to carry out the purposes of this subtitle. SEC. 135: DOCUMENTS. The Bureau shall, within 120 days follow- ing the date of the enactment of this Act, prepare both a "Program Brief" and "Im- plementation Guide" documents for each of the programs and projects contained in the formula grant program. SEC. 136. FUNCTIONS NOT TO BE TRANSFERRED. . The functions, powers, and, duties speci- fied in this subtitle to be carried out by the Bureau shall'not be transferred elsewhere in the Department of Justice unless specifi- cally hereafter authorized by the Congress by law. SEC. W. REIMBURSEMENTS. The Bureau may arrange with and reim- burse other Federal departments and agen- cies for the performance of functions under this subtitle only if the funds are to benefit the units of State or local government. Funds under this subtitle shall not be used to supplement the budgets of other Federal departments and agencies. SEC. 138. OFFICERS; EMPLOYEES. Subject to the civil service and classifica- tion laws, the Bureau is authorized to select,' appoint, employ, and fix the compensation of such officers and employees as shall be necessary to carry out its powers and duties under this subtitle. SEC. 139. PROGRAM AND PROJECT EVALUATION. (a) The Bureau shall provide for the de- velopment and, to the maximum extent fea- sible, implementation of procedures for the evaluation of programs and projects in terms of their success in achieving the ends for which they were intended, their con- formity with the purposes and goals of the State strategy, and their effectiveness in re- -ducing drug control problems. State and local units of government shall evaluate a reasonable number of programs and projects to be determined, and to provide such results to the Bureau. (b) The Bureau shall set aside 5 per centum of part C funds for the purpose of evaluation of programs and projects in part B and part C and the effectiveness of State strategy development and implementation in selected States. Such results shall be in- cluded in the State and Bureau reports. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90MOO005ROO1300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2863 SEC. 140. STATE PROGRAM AND PROJECT REPORTS. (a) Each State which receives a grant under part B of this subtitle shall submit to the Bureau, for each year in which any part of such grant is expended by a State or local unit of government, a report which con- tains- (1) a summary of the activities carried out with such grant and an assessment of the impact of such activities on meeting the needs identified in the State strategy sub- mitted under this subtitle; (2) a summary of activities carried out in such year with any grant received under part C of this subtitle by such State; (3) the evaluation result of programs and projects; and (4) such other information that the Bureau may require. (b) The report required by subsection (a) shall be submitted in such a form and by such time as the Bureau may require. SEC. 141. BUREAU PROGRAM AND PROJECT RE- PORTS. (a) Not later than 180 days after the end of each fiscal year for which grants are made under part B and part C of this sub- title, the Director shall submit to the Speaker of the House and the President pro tempore of the Senate a report that in- cludes with respect to each State= (1) the aggregate amount of grants made under parts B and C of this subtitle to such State for such fiscal year; (2) the amount of such grants expended for each of the programs specified in part B; (3) a summary-of the information provid- ed by the States required by this part; and (4) evaluation results of programs and projects and State strategy implementation. (b) Such report shall, in addition, be sub- mitted by the Director to the Committees on Appropriations of the House and Senate; and the Committees on the Judiciary of the Senate and the House for review. SEC. 142. EXPENDITURE OF GRANTS; REPORTS. (a) A grant made under part B Of this sub- title may not be expended for more than 60 per centum of the costs of the identified uses, in the aggregate, for which such grant is received to carry out any purpose speci- fied in part B, except that in the case of funds distributed to an Indian tribe which performs law enforcement functions (as de- termined by the Secretary of the Interior) for any such program or project, the amount of such grant shall be equal to 100 per centum of such costs. The non-Federal portion of the expenditures for such uses shall be paid in cash. (b)(1) Each State which receives a grant under part B of this subtitle shall keep, and shall require units of local government which receive any part of such grant, to keep, such records as the Director may re- quire to facilitate an effective audit. (2) The Director and the Comptroller General of the United States shall have access, for the purpose of audit and exami- nation, to any books, documents, and records of States, which receive grants, and of units of local government which receive any part of a grant made under part B, if in the opinion of the Director or the Comp- troller General, such books, documents, and records are related to the receipt or use of any such grant. PART G-FUNDING SEC. 143. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS. There are authorized to be appropriated, to carry out the grant programs authorized under this subtitle, $250,000,000 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989; $500,000,000 for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1990, of which up to 50 percent shall be used to continue the programs and projects for which grant funds were award- ed in fiscal year 1989; and $750,000,000 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1991, of which up to 50 percent shall be used to continue the programs and projects for which grant funds were awarded in fiscal years 1989 and 1990. SEC. 144. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL PER- SONNEL TO IMPLEMENT THE STATE AND LOCAL NARCOTICS CONTROL AS- SISTANCE ACT OF 1988. There is authorized to be appropriated, $5,000,000 in fiscal year 1989 for salaries and expenses of the Bureau of Justice Assist- ance: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by.the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or as provided in any reg- ular appropriation Act or continuing resolu- tion for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such addi- tional appropriation shall be used to hire an additional 96 fulltime equivalent positions and shall be used by the Bureau of Justice Assistance only for the purposes of carrying out the State and Local Narcotics Control Assistance Act of 1988, as authorized under this subtitle. PART II-RELATIONSHIP WITH THE JUSTICE ASSISTANCE ACT OF 1984 SEC. 145. ADMINISTRATION OF FUNDS. (a) The Bureau of Justice Assistance shall administer any funds available to it under the Omnibus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968 in such a manner as to compensate for the quantum increase in cases resulting from apprehensions and ac- celerated prosecution of persons accused of drug trafficking, possession, and related of- fenses. Such concentration of resources is intended to support the use of proven suc- cessful programs of such Act for courts and corrections agencies in processing drug cases and offenders. (b) State, metropolitan, and other jurisdic- tions are encouraged to participate in fund- ing under such Act and to integrate use of these monies with funds allocated under their drug statewide strategy in such a manner as to assure the smooth functioning of criminal justice administration in these jurisdictions. (c) The applicable program and project matching requirements of the Omnibus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968, currently set at 50 percent State/local, shall, on and after the effective date of this section, be the same as the 3-year sliding scale of increasing State and local contribu- tion established under section 127 of part B of this subtitle. Subtitle C-Chemical Diversion and Trafficking Act of 1988 SEC. 154. SHORT TITLE. This subtitle may be cited as the "Chemi- cal Diversion and Trafficking Act of 1988". SEC. 155. PRECURSOR CHEMICALS AND ESSENTIAL CHEMICALS. Section 310 of the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 830) is amended to read as follows: "PRECURSOR CHEMICALS AND ESSENTIAL CHEMICALS "SEC. 310. (a)(1)(A) Except as provided under paragraph (3), any person who manu- factures, distributes, imports or exports a Substance listed under subsection (d) shall maintain records and make reports as the Attorney General may by regulation require concerning the distribution, receipt, sale, importation or exportation of the listed sub- stances. "(B) Records required by this paragraph- "M shall be in a form that is readily re- trievable from ordinary business records; and "(ii) shall be kept and made available for inspection and copying by officers or em- ployees of the United States authorized by the Attorney General, with regard to sub- stances listed in subsection (d)(2), for 2 years and, with regard to substances listed in subsection (d)(1), for no less than 2 years and no more than 5 years as determined by regulation of the Attorney General. "(C) In establishing regulations concern- ing required records and reports under this paragraph, the Attorney General may es- tablish a threshold quantity for record- keeping and reporting requirements for each listed chemical. Reports required by the Attorney General shall be limited to those necessary for the effective implemen- tation of this title, such as reports ? of suspi- cious purchases. "(D) The Attorney General may include in the information required to be main- tained or reported under this paragraph the following: - "(i) The quantity, form, and manner in which, and date on which, the substance was distributed, imported or exported. "(Ii)(I) In the case of the distribution or exportation to an individual, the name, ad- dress, and age of the individual and the type of identification presented to establish the identity of the individual. "(II) In the case of the distribution or ex- portation to an entity other than an individ- ual, the name and address of the entity and the name, address, and title of the individ- ual ordering or receiving the substance and the type of identification presented to es- tablish the identity of the individual and of the entity. "(2)(A) Except as provided under para- graph (3), no person may distribute a sub- stance listed under subsection (d) unless the recipient or purchaser presents to the dis- tributor a certification of lawful use and identification in order to establish the iden- tity of the recipient or purchaser (and any entity which the recipient or purchaser rep- resents). "(B) The certification of lawful use and identification shall be of such a type as the Attorney General establishes by regulation. "(3) Under such conditions and to such extent as the Attorney General establishes, paragraphs (1) and (2) shall not apply to- "(A) the distribution of listed substances between agents or employees within a single facility (as defined by the Attorney Gener- al), if such agents or employees are acting in the lawful and usual course of their busi- ness or employment; "(B) the delivery of listed substances to or by a common or contract carrier for carriage in the lawful and usual course of.its busi- ness, or to or by a warehouseman for stor- age in the lawful and usual course of its business; but where such carriage or storage is in connection with the distribution, im- portation, or exportation of substances to a third person, this subparagraph shall not relieve the distributor, importer, or exporter from compliance with paragraph (1) or (2); "(C) any distribution, importation, or ex- portation with respect to which the Attor- ney General determines that the reports or records required by paragraph (1) or the presentation of identification or certifica- tion required by paragraph (2) is not neces- sary for the enforcement of this subchapter; or "(D) any distribution, importation, or ex- portation of any drug product which con- tains a listed substance and which can be lawfully marketed or distributed in the United States under the provisions of the Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act. "(b) It shall be unlawful for any person knowingly or intentionally- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90MOO005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 S 2864 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE "(1) to import into the customs territory of the United States from any place outside thereof (but within the United States), or to import into the United States from any place outside thereof, any substance listed under subsection (d) unless the substance is imported for commercial, scientific, or other legitimate uses, and is imported pursuant to such notification or declaration require- ments as the Attorney General may by reg- ulation prescribe; and "(2) to export from the United States to any other country a substance listed under subsection (d) unless there is furnished (before export) to, the Attorney General documentary proof that exportation is not contrary to the laws or regulations of the country of destination for consumption for medical, commercial, scientific, or other le- gitimate purposes, and is exported pursuant to such notification or declaration require ments as the Attorney General may by reg- ulation prescribe. "(c) The Attorney General may by rule- "(1) add substances to the list in subsec- tion (d) if the Attorney General finds that- "(A) such substance is a precursor or es- sential chemical which can be used to.manu- facture a controlled substance; and "(B) such substance is being used, in the manufacture of controlled substances in vio- lation of this title; or "(2) delete a substance listed in subsection (d) or added to the list by rule if the Attor- ney General finds that its listing no longer meets the criteria set forth in paragraph (1). "(d) The provisions of this title shall apply to the following: "(1) Precursor chemicals: "(A) N-Acetylanthranilic acid. "(B) Anthranille acid. "(C) Ergotamine tartrate. "(D) Ergonovine maleate. - "(E) Phenylacetic acid. "(F) Ephedrine. "(G) Pseudoephedrine. "(H) Benzyl cyanide. "(I) Benzyl chloride. "(J) Piperidine. "(2) Essential chemicals: "(A) Potassium permaganate.. "(B) Acetic anhydride. "(C) Acetone. "(D) Ethyl ether. "(e) Any information which is reported to or otherwise obtained by the Attorney Gen- eral under this section and which is exempt from disclosure pursuant to subsection (a) of section 552 of title 5, United States Code. by reason of subsection (b)(4) thereof shall be considered confidential and shall not be disclosed, except that such information may be disclosed to officers or employees of the United -States concerned with carrying out this title or title III or when relevant in any proceeding for the enforcement of this title or title III or when necessary to meet United States treaty obligations. "(f) For purposes of this title: "(1) The term 'import' has the meaning given such term in section 1001 of title III (21 U.S.C. 951(a)(1)). "(2) The term 'customs territory of the United States' has the meaning assigned to such term by section 1001 of title III (21 U.S.C. 951(a)(2)). "(g)(1) No person may distribute, sell, import, export, or otherwise transfer to an- other person any commercial tableting ma- chine or encapsulating machine unless the purchaser, recipient, transferee, or his agent presents to the distributor or supplier a cer- tification of lawful use and identification to establish the identity of the recipient or purchaser (and any entity which the recipi- ent or purchaser represents) of such a type as the Attorney General by regulation may establish. "(2) Any person who distributes, sells, im- ports, exports, or otherwise transfers to an- other person any commercial tableting ma- chine or encapsulating machine shall report the transfer to the Attorney General in such a form as the Attorney General may by regulation require. The Attorney Gener- al may require such information as the date of sale or transfer, name and address of transferee, purpose for which the machine is intended, and the serial numbers and make and model of the machine. "(h) An interested person (by petition) or the Attorney General may initiate action to add or delete chemicals pursuant to subsec- tion (c).". SEC. 156. CRIMINAL PENALTIES. (a) Section 401(d) of the Controlled Sub- stances Act (21 U.S.C. 841(d)(1)) is amended to read as follows: "(d) Any person who knowingly or inten- tionally- "(1) possesses any precursor chemical or essential chemical listed under section 310(d) with the intent to manufacture any controlled substance, except as authorized by this title; "(2) possesses or distributes any precursor chemical or essential chemical listed under section 310(d), knowing or having reasona- ble cause to believe, that such chemical so possessed or distributed will be used to man- ufacture a controlled substance, except as authorized by this title; "(3) manufactures, distributes, imports, or exports a precursor chemical or essential chemical listed under section 310(d) except as provided for by this title, "(4) possesses any precursor chemical or essential chemical listed under section 310(d), with knowledge that the recordkeep- ing or reporting requirements of section 310(a) or regulations issued pursuant to sec- tion 310(a) have not been complied with, or "(5) with the intent of causing the evasion of the recordkeeping or reporting require- ments of section 310(a) of the regulations issued thereunder, receives or distributes a reportable amount of any chemical listed under section 310(d) in units small enough so that the making of records or filing of re- ports under section 310(a) is not required, shall be sentenced to a term of imprison-_ meet of not more than 5 years, a fine not to exceed the greater of that authorized In ac- cordance with the provisions of title 18, United States Code, or $250,000 if the de- fendant is an individual or $1,000,000 if the defendant is other than an individual, or both.". (b) Section 402(a)(9) of the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 842(a)(9)) is amended by- (1) striking out "or sell piperidine" and re- placing it with "a precursor chemical or es- sential chemical listed under section 310(d)"; and (2) adding "or certification" after "identi- fication". (c) Section 402(c)(2) of the Controlled ,Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 842(c)(2)) is amended by striking out subparagraph (C). (d) Section 403(a) of the Controlled Sub- stances Act (21 U.S.C. 843(a)) is amended- (1) in clause (4)(B) by striking out "piperi- dine" and inserting in lieu thereof "a pre- cursor chemical or essential chemical listed under section 310(d)"; (2) in clause (4)(B) by adding "or certifi- cate" after "identification" where It ap- pears; (3) in paragraph (4) by striking out "or" after the semicolon; March 28, 1988 (4) in paragraph (5) by striking out the period and inserting in lieu thereof ' ; or"; and (5) by adding the following paragraphs at the end thereof: "(6) to possess any drug manufacturing equipment, tableting or encapsulating ma- chines, or gelatin capsules with intent to manufacture a controlled substance except as authorized by this title; or "(7) to manufacture, distribute, or import any drug manufacturing equipment, tablet- Ing or encapsulating machines, or gelatin capsules knowing, or having reasonable cause to believe, that they will be used to manufacture a controlled substance except as authorized by this title.". (e) Section 403(c) of the Controlled Sub- stances Act (21 U.S.C. 843(c)) is amended by adding at the end thereof the following. "In addition, any person convicted of a violation of this section or section 401 relating to the receipt, distribution, importation, or expor- tation of substances listed in section 310(d) shall be enjoined from conducting business activities involving such substances for a minimum of 10 years.". (f) Section 1961(1) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by inserting "in- cluding precursor and essential chemicals (as defined in section 310 of the Controlled Substances Act)," after "dangerous drugs," each time it appears. (g) Section 2516(1)(e) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by inserting "'in- cluding precursor and essential 'chemicals (as defined in section 310 of the Controlled Substances Act)," after "dangerous drugs,". SEC. 157. FORFEITURES. Section 511(a) of the Controlled Sub- stances Act (21 U.S.C. 881) is amended by adding a new paragraph (9) as follows: "(9) All chemicals listed under section 310(d), all drug manufacturing equipment, all tableting or encapsulating machines, and all gelatin. capsules. which have been im- ported, exported, manufactured, possessed, distributed, or intended to be distributed, in violation of this title; as well as all convey- ances and equipment, including aircraft, ve- hicles; or vessels, which are used, or are in- tended for use, to transport, or in any way facilitate the transportation; distribution, receipt, possession, or concealment of pre- cursor chemicals and essential chemicals, drug manufacturing equipment, tableting or encapsulating machines, or gelatin capsules, in violation of this title, except as provided for under subparagraphs (A) and (B) of paragraph (4).". SEC: 158. DEFINITIONS. Section 102 of the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 802) is amended- (1) in paragraph (11), by inserting after "a controlled substance" both places it appears the following: "or a precursor chemical or essential chemical listed under section 310(d)"; (2) in paragraph (8), by inserting "or a precursor chemical or essential chemical" after "a controlled substance"; and (3) by adding at the end thereof the fol- lowing new paragraphs: "(33) The term 'precursor chemical' means a substance that may be used In the chemical process of manufacturing con- trolled substances and which is incorporated into the final product and is therefore criti- cal to its manufacture. "(34) The term-'essential chemical' means a substance that may be used in the chemi- cal process of manufacturing controlled sub- stances as a solvent, reagent, or catalyst.". SEC 169. TECHNICAL AMENDMENTS. (a) Section 506(a) of the Controlled Sub- stances Act (21 U.S.C. 876(a)) is amended by Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2865 adding "or precursor chemicals or essential chemicals" after "with respect to controlled substances". (b) The table of sections for part C of the Controlled Substances Act is amended by striking out the item relating to section 310 and inserting the following in lieu thereof: "310. Precursor chemicals and essential chemicals.". SEC. 160. ACTIVE DEPARTMENT OF JUSTICE CON. TROL PROGRAM. The Attorney General shall maintain an active program, both domestic and intetria- tional, to curtail the diversion of precursor chemicals and essential chemicals used in the illicit manufacture of controlled sub- stances. This program shall include appro- priate controls on the purchase, sale, import, and export of these chemicals and development of cooperative efforts with for- eign drug control authorities. SEC. 161. EFFECTIVE DATE. This subtitle shall take effect 120 days after the date of enactment of this Act. Subtitle D-Comprehensive Federal Law Enforcement Officer Improvements Act of 1988 SEC. 171. SHORT TITLE. This subtitle may be cited as the "Com- prehensive Federal Law Enforcement Offi- cer Improvements Act of 1988". SEC. 172. RESTORATION OF HAZARDOUS DUTY EARLY RETIREMENT OPTION UNDER FEDERAL EMPLOYEES' RETIREMENT SYSTEM. Section 8401(17)(E) of title 5, United States Code, is amended by striking out "for at least 10 years" and inserting in lieu there- of "for at least 3 years". SEC. 173. AMENDMENTS TO THE OMNIBUS CRIME CONTROL AND SAFE STREETS ACT OF 1968. (a) Section 1201(a) of title I of the Omni- bus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968 (42 U.S.C. 3796(a)) is amended by strik- ing out "$50,000" and inserting in lieu there- of "$100,000". (b) Section 1201(a)(4) of title I of the Om- nibus Crime Control and Safe Streets Act of 1968 (42. U.S.C. 3796(a)(4)) is amended by striking out "dependent". SEC. 174. DEFINITIONS. As used in this section and sections 176, 177, and 178- (1) the term "Commission" means the Na- tional Advisory Commission on Law En- forcement; (2) the term "Commissioner" means a member of the National Advisory Commis- sion on Law Enforcement; and (3) the term "law enforcement officer" has the same meaning as provided in section 8401(17) of title 5, United States Code. SEC. 175. ESTABLISHMENT AND PURPOSES OF THE NATIONAL ADVISORY COMMISSION ON LAW ENFORCEMENT. (a) There is established as an independent commission in the legislative branch of the United States a National Advisory Commis- sion on Law Enforcement, which shall con- sist of the following members: (1) four members of the United States Senate, two of whom shall be selected by the Majority Leader and two of whom shall be selected by the Minority Leader; (2) four members of the United States House of Representatives, two of whom shall be selected by the Speaker and two of whom shall be selected by the Minority Leader, (3) the Comptroller General of the United States, who shall also serve as Chairman of the Commission; (4) the Director of the Office of Personnel Management; (5) the Attorney General of the United States and three other officials of the. De- partment of Justice who shall be designated by the Attorney General; (6) the Secretary of the Treasury and two other officials of the Department of the Treasury who shall be designated by the Secretary of the Treasury; (7) the Inspector Generals of three de- partments or agencies of the executive branch of the United States who shall be designated by the President of the United States; and (8) three representatives from Federal em- ployee groups to be selected by the Office of Personnel Management after consultation with the Speaker of the House and the Ma- jority Leader of the Senate. (b) The Commission shall study the meth- ods and rates of compensation, including salary, overtime pay, and other benefits of law enforcement' officers in all Federal agencies, as well as the methods and rates of compensation of State and local law en- forcement officers in a representative number of areas where Federal law enforce- ment officers are assigned, in order to deter- mine- (1) the differences which exist among Federal agencies with regard to the meth- ods and rates of compensation for law en- forcement officers; (2) the rational basis, if any, for such dif- ferences, considering the nature of the re- sponsibilities of the law enforcement offi- cers in each agency; the qualifications and training required to perform such responsi- bilities; the degree of personal risk to which the law enforcement officers in each agency are normally exposed in the performance of their duties; and such other factors as the Commission deems relevant in evaluating -the differences in compensation among the various agencies; (3) the extent to which inequities appear to exist among Federal agencies with regard to the methods and rates of compensation of law enforcement officers, based on con- sideration of the factors mentioned in para- graph (2) of this subsection; (4) the feasibility of devising a uniform system of overtime compensation for law enforcement officers in all or most Federal agencies, with due regard for both the spe- cial needs of law enforcement officers and the relative cost effectiveness to the Gov- ernment of such a system compared to those currently in use; (5) how the salaries paid to Federal law enforcement officers compare to those of State and local officers in the same geo- graphical area, especially those in "high cost-of-living" areas; (6) the impact of the rates of compensa- tion paid by various Federal agencies on the lifestyle, morale, and general well-being of law enforcement officers, including their ability to subsist; (7) the recruiting and retention problems experienced by Federal agencies due to: in- equities in compensation among such agen- cies; the differences between rates of com- pensation paid to Federal law enforcement officers and State and local officers in the same geographical areas; and other factors related to compensation; and (8) the extent to which Federal legislation and administrative regulations may be nec- essary or appropriate to rectify inequities among Federal agencies in the methods and rates of compensation for law enforcement officers; to address the lack of uniformity among agencies with regard to overtime pay; to provide premiums or special rates of pay for Federal law enforcement officers in high cost-of-living areas; to ensure that the levels of compensation paid to Federal law enforcement officers will be competitive with those paid to State and local officers in the same geographical areas; and to address such other matters related to the determi- nations made under this subsection as the Commission deems appropriate in the inter- ests of enhancing the ability of Federal agencies to recruit and retain the most qualified and capable law enforcement offi- cers. SEC. 176. POWERS OF THE COMMISSION. (a) The Commission shall have the power to- (1) utilize, with their consent, the services, equipment, personnel, information, and fa- cilities of other Federal, State. local, and private agencies and instrumentalities with or without reimbursement therefor; (2) enter into and perform, without regard to section 3324 of title 31, United States Code, such contracts, leases, cooperative agreements, and other transactions as may be necessary in the conduct of the functions of the Commission, with any public agency, or with any person, firm, association, corpo- ration, educational Institution, or nonprofit organization; - - (3) request such information, data, and re- ports from any Federal agency or instru- mentality as the Commission may from time to time require and as may be produced con- sistent with other law; and (4) hold hearings and call witnesses that might assist the Commission in the exercise of its powers or duties. (b) The Commission shall have such other powers as may be necessary to carry out its functions under this Act and may delegate to any member or designated person such powers as may be appropriate in the con- duct of its functions. (c) Upon the request of the Commission, each Federal agency is authorized and di- rected to make its resources, services, equip- ment, personnel, facilities, and information available to the greatest practicable extent to the Commission in the execution of its functions. (d) Each Commissioner may utilize the re- sources, services, equipment, personnel, in- formation, and facilities of his or her Feder- al agency or, in the case of the Commission- ers who are members of Congress, his or her congressional office, as may be necessary in the conduct of the Commissioner's respec- tive functions as a member of the Commis- sion. (e) A simple majority of the Commission- ers then serving shall constitute a quorum for the conduct of business by the Commis- sion, and the Commission may exercise its powers and fulfill its duties by the vote of a simple majority of the Commissioners present. (f) The Chairman of the Commission shall call and preside at meetings of the Commis- sion, but the Chairman may delegate to any other Commissioner the authority to pre- side at meetings of the Commission. SEC. 177. REPORT AND DISSOLUTION OF COMMIS. SION. (a) Within 6 months following the date of enactment of this Act, the Commission shall prepare and deliver to the President of the United States, the President of the Senate, and the Speaker of the House of Represent- atives, a written report setting forth- (1) the findings and determinations made by the Commission pursuant to section 176(b); and (2) specific proposals for such legislation and administrative regulations as'the Com- mission has determined to be necessary or appropriate pursuant to section 176(b)(8). (b) The Commission shall be terminated 60 -days following submission of the report mandated by this section. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2866 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE Subtitle E-Deportation of Convicted Foreign Drug Inmates SEC. 182. SHORT TITLE. This subtitle may be cited as the "Violent CriminalAlien Deportation Act". SEC. 183. DEFINITIONS. (a) The term "violent criminal alien" for purposes of this subtitle means any alien, including an alien crewman, who has been convicted and sentenced for an aggravated violent felony in a United States district court or in a court of record of any State, territory, possession, or in the District of Columbia. (b) The term "aggravated violent felony" for purposes of this subtitle means (1) any offense, attempt, or conspiracy involving murder, assault and battery against a police officer, peace officer, or other law enforce- ment officer, kidnapping, arson, robbery, ex- tortion, burglary, rape, forcible sodomy, or dealing in narcotic or other dangerous drugs which is chargeable under State law and punishable by imprisonment for more-than one year, or (2) any offense or conspiracy to commit any offense which is indictable under any of the following provisions of the United States Code; 18 U.S.C. 111 (relating to assault on a Federal officer); 18 U.S.C. 351 (relating to assault of a Member of Con- gress, Cabinet officer, or Supreme Court Justice); 18 U.S.C. 891-894 (relating to ex- tortionate credit transactions); 18 U.S.C. 1114 (relating to the homicide of a Federal law enforcement officer); 18 U.S.C. 1201 (re- lating to kidnapping); 18 U.S.C. 1751 (relat- ing to the homicide of the President); 18 U.S.C. 1951, 1952, 1952A, and 1952B (relat- ing to interference with commerce by threats or violence); 18 U.S.C. 2113 and 2118 (relating to robbery); 18 U.S.C. 2421-24 (re- lating to white slave traffic); subsections (i), (j), (k), and (1) of section 902 of the Federal Aviation Act of 1958 (relating to aircraft piracy); or the felonious manufacture, im- portation, receiving, concealment, buying, selling, or otherwise dealing in narcotic or other dangerous drugs, including precursor and essential chemicals (as defined in sec- tion 310 of the Controlled Substances Act), punishable under any law of the United, States. SEC. 184. ADDITIONAL GROUNDS FOR DEPORTA. TION; GROUNDS FOR APPEAL. (a) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, except section 243(h) of the Immi- gration and Nationality Act, any alien in the United States (including an alien crewman) shall, upon the order of the Attorney Gen- eral, be deported as a violent criminal alien if such alien has been convicted and sen- tenced in a United States district court or in a court of record of any State, territory, possession, or in the District of Columbia for an aggravated violent felony and such conviction and sentence shall revoke by op- eration of law the permanent resident status of any alien and such conviction and sentence shall serve as conclusive evidence of the deportability of any alien. (b) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the District Director of the Immigra- tion and Naturalization Service for the dis- trict in which it appears that an alien was convicted and sentenced for an aggravated violent felony shall, on behalf of the Attor- ney General, issue and order of deportation for the alleged violent criminal alien which shall be effective as of the date of sentence. (c) Notwithstanding any other provision .of law, an order of deportation for an al- leged violent criminal alien, in his native language, shall be personally served on the alleged violent criminal alien named there- in. Said order of deportation shall be simply worded to inform the alleged violent crimi- nal alien of at least the following informa- tion: (1) the data and the court in which the subject of the order of deportation.was con- victed and sentenced for an alleged aggra- vated violent felony; (2) a description, including the citation, of the crime alleged to be the aggravated vio- lent felony; (3) a notice that the order of deportation will become a final order of deportation unless the subject of the order petitions a United States district court to vacate the order of deportation within 30 days of its personal service on the alleged violent crimi- nal alien; and (4) an explanation of the procedure to vacate the order of deportation. (d)(1) Notwithstanding any other provi- sion of law, a person alleged to be a violent criminal alien may petition a United States district court to vacate an order of deporta- tion on the grounds that he is a United States citizen and therefore not subject to an order of deportation, that he is not the person named in the order of deportation as having been convicted and sentenced for the aggravated violent felony which is the basis for the order of deportation, or that the conviction which is the basis for the order of deportation is not an aggravated violent felony as that term is defined in this Act. (2) A petition to vacate an order of depor- tation by the person named therein as a vio- lent criminal alien must set forth under oath the ground or grounds, set forth in subsection (a), upon which the alleged vio- lent criminal alien seeks to vacate his order of deportation. If petitioner claims United States citizenship, he must allege the names of his natural mother and father and the date and place of his birth. (3) A petition by an alleged violent crimi- nal alien to vacate an order of deportation must be served on the United States Attor- ney for the judicial district in which the pe- tition is filed. Within 30 days of service upon the appropriate United States Attor- ney, a reply shall be filed with the district court and served upon the alleged violent criminal alien or his attorney acknowledg- ing or disputing, with appropriate documen- tary evidence, the ground or grounds al- leged in the petition as the basis to vacate the order of deportation. (4) Within 30 days of the service on the al- leged violent criminal alien or his attorney of the reply of the United States Attorney, a United States district judge may conduct a hearing, without a jury, to resolve any dis- puted questions of fact as to whether the person alleged to be a violent criminal alien is a United States citizen, or as to whether the person who is the subject of the order of deportation was convicted and sentenced for an aggravated violent felony as that term is defined in this Act, or as to whether the crime alleged in the order of deporta- tion is an aggravated violent felony as that term is defined in this Act. The burden of proof by a preponderance of the evidence is upon the petitioner to establish United States citizenship and the burden of proof by a preponderance of evidence Is upon the United States to establish that the person named in the order of deportation is peti- tioner or that petitioner was convicted and sentenced for an aggravated violent felony, as that term is defined in this Act. The Fed- eral Rules of Evidence shall apply to this hearing. At the conclusion of the hearing the United States district court must make a finding as to whether, petitioner is a vio- lent criminal alien and thus subject to de- portation pursuant to this Act. If petitioner is adjudicated a violent criminal alien, the court shall -issue a final order of deporta- tion. March 23, 1988 (5) Petitioner may appeal a final order of deportation, issued pursuant to this subtitle, to the appropriate United States court of appeals, and said order of deportation shall be stayed pending the decision and order of the court of appeals. The United States may appeal the vacatur of an order of deporta- tion, issued pursuant to this subtitle, to the appropriate United States court of appeals. (e) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, when the conviction and sentence of an aggravated violent felony, which served as the basis for the deportation of a person who had previously been lawfully admitted for permanent residence, is reversed by a United States district court or by a court of record of any State, territory, possession, or in the District of Columbia, the alien may petition the Attorney General from his native country for discretionary reinstate- ment of the status of an alien lawfully ad- mitted for permanent residence. (f) Nothing in this subtitle shall be con- strued as altering the authority of a special inquiry officer with respect to proceedings to determine the deportability- of aliens other than violent criminal aliens. SEC. 185. AMENDMENTS. Section 276 of the Immigration and Na- tionality Act is amended- (1) by striking out "Any alien" and insert- ing in lieu thereof "(a) Subject to subsection (b), any alien", and (2) by adding at the end thereof the fol- lowing: "(b)(1) Notwithstanding subsection (a), in the case of any alien described in subsection (a)- "(A) whose deportation was subsequent to a conviction for commission of a felony (other than an aggravated violent felony), such alien shall be punishable by imprison- ment for not more than 5 years, or a fine of not more than $10,000, or both, or "(B) whose deportation was subsequent to a conviction of commission of an aggravated violent felony, such alien shall be punish- able by imprisonment for not more than 15 years and by a fine of not more than $20,000. "(2) For purposes of this subsection, the term 'aggravated violent felony' is as de- fined in section 183(b) of the Violent Crimi- nal Alien Deportation Act.". Subtitle F-Customs Enforcement Amendments Act of 1988 SEC. 187. SHORT TITLE: AMENDMENTS. (a) This subtitle may be cited as the "Cus- toms Enforcement Amendments Act of 1988". (b)(1) Section 1956(c)(7)(D) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by striking out "section 543" and inserting "section 545". (2) Section 1822(e) of the Mail Order Drug Paraphernalia Control Act is amended by striking out "upon conviction- of a person for such violation". SEC. 188. AMENDMENTS TO THE TARIFF ACT OF 1930. (a) Section 431(c)(1)(G) of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1431(c)(1)(G)) is amended by striking out "or" and inserting in lieu thereof "of". (b) Section 433 of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1433) is amended by- (1) striking out the section heading and inserting in lieu thereof: "SEC. 433. VESSELS, VEHICLES, AND AIRCRAFT RE- PORTING REQUIREMENTS."; (2) striking out "ARRIVAL" and inserting in lieu thereof "REPORTING REQUIREMENTS" in the caption of subsection (c); (3) redesignating the content of subsec- tion (c) as subsection (c)(1); and Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE (4) inserting the following at the end of subsection (c)(1): "(2) The pilot of any aircraft shall, prior to departing the United States, comply with such advance notification and reporting re- quirements as the Secretary may by regula- tion prescribe.". (c) Section 436 of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1436) is amended by- (1) inserting ", except for violations of sec- tion 433(c)(2)," after "listed in subsection (a)" in subsection (b); and (2) inserting the following new subsection after subsection (d): "(e) Any aircraft pilot who commits any violation of section 433(c)(2) of this Act, or any regulations promulgated thereunder, is liable for a civil penalty of $25,000 for the first, violation, and $100,000 for each subse- quent violation, and any conveyance used in connection with any such violation is sub- ject to seizure and forfeiture.". (d) Section 497(a)(2)(A) of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1497), is amended by striking out "200 percent " and inserting in lieu thereof "1,000 percent". (e) Section 581 of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1581) is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new subsection: "(i) For purposes of this section, the term 'authorized place' includes- "(1) with respect to a vehicle, any location in a foreign country at which United States customs officers are permitted to conduct inspections, examinations, or searches; "(2) with respect to a vessel- "(A) the high seas if the vessel is- "(I) a vessel of the United States as de- fined in section 3 of Public Law 96-350 (46 U.S.C. 1903) or section 3 of the Anti-Smug- gling Act (19 U.S.C. 1703); "(ii) a vessel registered in a foreign nation or a vessel with a foreign nationality where the flag state has consented or waived ob- jection to boardings or examinations by United States officials; or "(iii) a vessel without nationality or a vessel assimilated to a vessel without nation- ality, in accordance with paragraph (2) or article 6 of the 1958 Convention on the High Seas; and "(B) the territorial seas, internal waters, or contiguous zone of a foreign country, if that country consents to boardings or ex- aminations by United States officials; and "(3) with respect to aircraft to which this section applies by virtue of section .644 or section 1109 of the Federal Aviation Act (49 U.S.C. 1509) or regulations issued thereun- der, any location in a foreign country at which' United States customs officers are permitted to conduct inspections, examina- tion, or searches.". (f) Section 609 of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1609) is amended by- (1) adding the following sentence at the end of subsection (a): "A declaration of for- feiture under this section shall have the same force and effect as a final decree and order of forfeiture in a judicial forfeiture proceeding in" a United States District Court. Title shall be deemed to vest in the United States free and clear of any liens or encumbrances (except for first preferred ship mortgages pursuant to 46 U.S.C. 961) from the date of the act for which the for- feiture was incurred. Officials of the various States, insular, possessions, territories and commonwealths shall, upon application of the appropriate customs officer accompa- nied by a certified copy of the declaration of forfeiture, remove any recorded liens. or en- cumbrances which apply to such property and issue or reissue the necessary certifi- cates of title, registration certificates, or similar documents to the United States or to any transferee of the United States."; and (2) by striking out "During the period be- ginning on October 30, 1984, and ending on September 30, 1987, the" in subsection (b) and inserting in lieu thereof "The". (g) Subsection (c) of section 616 of the Tariff Act of 1930 (19 U.S.C. 1616a(c)) is amended by- (1) inserting "is authorized to retain for- feited property for official use, or the Secre- tary" after "the Secretary of the Treasury"; and (2) striking out "which participated direct- ly in the seizure or forfeiture of the proper- ty" and inserting in lieu thereof "that coop- erates with the United States Customs Serv- ice in joint law enforcement operations. The Secretary is also authorized to transfer for- feited property to foreign governments that cooperate with the United States Customs Service in joint law enforcement oper- ations". (h) Part V of title IV of the Tariff Act of 1930 is amended by inserting the following new section after section 619: "SEC. 630. FINES IN CERTAIN CASES. "Any person who is convicted of a crimi- nal offense under any law administered or enforced by the Customs Service involving the Bank Secrecy Act (31 U.S.C. 5311-5322), Money Laundering (18 U.S.C. 1956 and 1957), or the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 801 et seq.), shall be fined the reason- able costs of the investigation and prosecu- tion of the offense, including the costs of prosecution of an.offense as defined in sec- tions 1918 and 1920 of title 28, United States Code, except that this sentence shall not apply, and a fine under this section need not be imposed, if the court determines under the provision of title 18 of such Code that the defendant lacks the ability to pay.". SEC. 189. THE STAMPING OF CONTROLLED SUB- STANCE VIOLATORS' PASSPORTS ACT OF 1988. (a) The Secretary of State is authorized to make regulations prescribing procedures for indicating on passports and other travel documents issued by the United States, the fact that the holder has been convicted of an offense under a Federal or State law in- volving controlled substances, or has been assessed a fine or civil penalty or has in- curred a forfeiture under any Federal or State law involving controlled substances as defined by section 102 of the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 802(6)). (b) Upon conviction of any violation of a Federal or State law involving controlled substances as defined by the Controlled Substances Act, or any criminal violation of the Bank Secrecy Act (31 U.S.C. 5311-5322), or Money Laundering Act (18 U.S.C. 1956 and 1957), the Secretary of State shall revoke violators passports and other travel documents. (c) A person whose passport or other travel documents shall have been revoked under subsection (b) of this section for an offense constituting a felony, shall not be eligible to receive a passport or other travel documents for 10 years from the date of the conviction of the crime resulting in revoca- tion. A person whose passport or other travel documents shall have been revoked under subsection (b) of this section for an offense constituting a misdemeanor, shall not be eligible to receive a passport or other travel documents for 5 years from the date of the conviction of the crime resulting in revocation. (d) No passport or other travel document shall be issued to a person who has been convicted of a Federal or State felony in- volving controlled substances as defined by the Controlled Substances Act or any crimi- nal violation of the Bank Secrecy Act-(31 U.S.C. 5311-5322), or Money Laundering Act S 2867 (18 U.S.C. 1956 and 1957), during the 20- year period prior to the application. No passport or other travel document shall be issued to a person who has been convicted of a Federal or State offense constituting a misdemeanor involving controlled sub- stances as defined by the Controlled Sub- stances Act or any criminal violation of the Bank Secrecy Act (31 U.S.C. 5311-5322), or Money Laundering Act (18 U.S.C. 1956 and 1957), during the 5-year period prior to the application. SEC. 190. AMENDMENT TO'THE TARIFF ACT OF 1930. Part V of title IV of the Tariff Act of 1930 is amended by inserting the following new section after section 630: "SEC. 631. OATHS AND SUBPENAS. "(a) IN GENERAL.-For the purpose of any investigation which, in the opinion of the Secretary of the Treasury, is necessary and proper to the enforcement of any law relat- ing to the importation or exportation of any prohibited merchandise, the Secretary of the Treasury may administer oaths and af- firmations, subpena witnesses, compel their attendance, take evidence, and require the production of records (including books, papers, documents, and tangible things which constitute or contain evidence) rele- vant or material to the investigation. The attendance of witnesses and the production of records may be required from any place within the customs territory of the United States, except that a witness shall not be re- quired to appear at any hearing distant more than 100 miles from the place where he was served with subpena. Witnesses sum- moned by the Secretary shall be paid the same fees and mileage that are paid wit- nesses in the courts of the United States. Oaths and affirmations may be made at any place subject to the jurisdiction of the United States. "(b) SERVICE OF SUBPENAS.-A subpena of the Secretary of the Treasury may be served by any person designated in the sub- pena, to serve it. Service upon a natural person may be made by personal delivery of the subpena to him. Service may be made upon a domestic or foreign corporation or upon a partnership or other unincorporated association which is subject to suit under a common name, by delivering the subpena to an officer, a managing or general agent, or to any other agent authorized by appoint- ment or by law to receive service of process. The affidavit of the person serving the sub- pena entered on a true copy thereof by the person serving it shall be proof of service. "(C) ORDERS To COMPEL COMPLIANCE.-In the case of contumacy by, or refusal to obey a subpena issued to, any person, the Secre- tary of the Treasury may invoke the aid of any court of the United States within the jurisdiction of which the investigation is carried on, or of which the subpenaed person is an inhabitant, carries on business, or may be found, to compel compliance with the subpena of the Secretary of the Treas- ury. The court may issue an order requiring the subpenaed person to appear before the Secretary of the Treasury there to produce records, if so ordered, or to give testimony touching the matter under investigation, and pay the costs of the proceeding. Any failure to obey the order of the court may be punished by the court as a contempt thereof. All process in any such case may be served in the judicial district whereof the subpenaed person is an inhabitant or wher- ever he may be found.". SEC. 191. AMENDMENT TO TITLE 18. UNITED STATES . (a) Section 1961(1)(B) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by inserting "sec- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 S 2868 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE tion 545 (relating.to smuggling)" immediate- ly after "relating to counterfeiting),". (b) Section 1981(1)(D) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by striking out "or" immediately after the last comma. (c) Section 1961(1) of title 18, United States Code, is amended by inserting imme- diately before the semicolon at the end thereof a comma and the following new clauses: "(F) any act which is indictable under section 38 of the Foreign Military Sales Act (relating to the illegal exportation of munitions) (22 U.S.C. 2778), (G) any act which is indictable under section 11 of the Export Administration Act of 1979 (relating to the illegal exportation of merchandise) (50 U.S.C. Appendix 2410), or section 3 of the Trading With the Enemy Act (relating to criminal violations), or (H) any act which is indictable under section 203 of the Inter- national Emergency Economic Powers Act (relating to criminal sanctions) (50 U.S.C. 1702)". (d) Subsection (f) of section 1109 of the Federal Aviation Act of 1958 is amended by adding the following sentence to the end thereof: "Any person who violates this subsection or any regulation promulgated thereunder shall be subject to a civil penalty of $10,000, and any aircraft for which a report required under this subsection or any regulation pro- mulgated thereunder is not filed, or is filed with material false statements or omissions, shall be subject to seizure and forfeiture as provided for in the Customs laws.". Subtitle G-Authorization of Additional Appro- priations for Drug Enforcement Personnel, Fiscal Year 1989 SEC. 192. UNITED STATES COAST GUARD DRUG INTERDICTION PERSONNEL ENHANCE- MENT. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated for Operating Expenses of the Coast Guard for fiscal year 1989, $45,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided fur- ther, That such additional appropriations shall be used to increase Coast Guard drug enforcement personnel by no less than 800 full-time equivalent positions over personnel levels onboard in the Coast Guard as of Sep- tember 30, 1988. (b) Nothing in this section shall require the Coast Guard to recruit, compensate, train, purchase, or deploy any personnel or equipment except to the extent that- (1) additional appropriations are made available in appropriations Acts for that purpose; or (2) funds are transferred to the Secretary of Transportation for that purpose pursu- ant to this Act. SEC. 193. UNITED STATES CUSTOMS SERVICE DRUG INTERDICTION PERSONNEL ENHANCE- MENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses of the Customs Serv- ice for fiscal year 1989, $30,000,000: Provid- ed, That such appropriation shall be in addi- tion to any appropriations requested by the President in his budget presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or appropri- ated in any regular appropriations Act or continuing resolution for the fiscal year ending on September 30, 1989: Provided fur- ther, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase drug enforcement personnel at the Customs Service by no fewer than. 600 full-time equivalent posi- tions over the level of such personnel on- board at the Customs Service as of Septem- ber 30, 1988, and for related equipment. SEC. 194. IMMIGRATION AND NATURALIZATION SERVI('E/HORDER PATROL DRUG INTERDICTION PERSONNEL ENHANCE- MENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses of the Border Patrol within the Department of Justice for fiscal year 1989, $20,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his budget presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or appropriated in any regular appropriations Act or continuing resolution for the fiscal year ending on Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase drug interdiction officers of the Border Patrol by no fewer than 500 full- time equivalent positions over the level of such personnel onboard at the Border Patrol as of September 30, 1988, and for re- lated equipment: Provided further, That of these additional personnel, 90 shall be for drug interdiction support personnel and 10 for Border Patrol drug education officers. SEC. 195. IMMIGRATION AND NATURALIZATION SERVICE/CRIMINAL INVESTIGATOR PERSONNEL ENHANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses for the Immigration and Naturalization Service for fiscal year 1989, $3,000,000: Provided, That such appro- priation shall be in addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriations shall be used to increase the number of criminal investi- gator full-time equivalent positions by 50 over such personnel levels onboard at the Service as of September 30, 1988, and for re- lated equipment. SEC. 195A. ORGANIZED CRIME DRUG ENFORCE. MENT TASK FORCE, NEW YORK CITY PILOT PROJECT AND REPORT. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated to the Immigration and Naturalization Serv- ice in the Department of Justice for fiscal year 1989, $16,100,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided, That such addi- tional appropriation shall be used to in- crease the commitment of Immigration and Naturalization. Service personnel to the Or- ganized Crime Drug Enforcement Task Force (OCDETF) in New York City, by 175 Senior Special Agent and support positions; and for associated training and equipment; and for costs incurred during INS agent par- ticipation in OCDETF operations with other Federal, State, and local law enforce- ment agencies. (b) The aforementioned positions shall, under the supervision of a director for the pilot project, be used exclusively to assist Federal and local law enforcement agencies in combatting illegal alien involvement in drug trafficking and crimes of violence. (c) The director of the pilot project shall report to the Assistant Commissioner-In- vestigations and will have the authority to- -(1) hire a limited number of non-Federal law enforcement officers with substantive experience in narcotics investigations should insufficient senior Federal agents be available. Non-Federal law enforcement of- ficers hired under this provision may be over the age of 35, but in that event would only be eligible for nonlaw enforcement re- tirement benefits. March 231 1988 (2) grant extensions of stay and other dis- cretionary Immigration benefits and waivers to witnesses, informants, and others whose presence in the United States is essential to the investigation and prosecution of crimi- nal aliens involved In drug trafficking and crimes of violence. (d) After the first year of the establish- ment of this pilot project the Attorney Gen- eral will provide for an evaluation of its ef- fectiveness, including an assessment by Fed- eral local prosecutors and enforcement agencies. SEC. 196. BUREAU OF ALCOHOL, TOBACCO, AND FIREARMS ARMED CAREER CRIMINAL APPREHENSION PROGRAM PERSON- NEI, ENHANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses of the Bureau of Al- cohol, Tobacco, and Firearms for fiscal year 1989, $8,000,000: Provided, That such appro- priation shall be in addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase the number of Armed Career Criminal Apprehension enforcement per- sonnel at the Bureau by no less than 130 fulltime equivalent positions over such per- sonnel levels onboard at the Bureau as of September 30, 1988, and for related equip- ment: Provided further, That an additional 10 fulltime equivalent positions shall be used to establish a Bureau of Alcohol, To- bacco, and Firearms Drug Education offi- cers program: Provided further, That of the amount authorized to be appropriated by this section, $750,000 shall be available for (1) the equipping for law enforcement func- tions of any vessel, vehicle, equipment, or aircraft available for official use by a State or local law enforcement agency if the con- veyance will be used in joint law enforce- ment operations with the Bureau- of Alco- hol, Tobacco, and Firearms, and (2) the pay- ment of overtime salaries, travel, fuel, train- ing, equipment, and other similar costs of State and local law enforcement officers that are incurred in joint operations with the Bureau of Alcohol, Tobacco, and Fire- arms. SEC. 197. DRUG ENFORCEMENT ADMINISTRATION PERSONNEL ENHANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses of the Drug Enforce- ment Administration for fiscal year 1989, $60,000,000: Provided, That such appropria- tion shall be in addition to any appropria- tions requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolu- tions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such addi- tional appropriation shall be used to in- crease Drug Enforcement Administration enforcement personnel by no less than 224 fulltime equivalent positions over personnel levels onboard at the Drug Enforcement Ad- ministration as of September 30, 1988, and for related equipment and drug enforce- ment operations: Provided further, That of these additional positions, 5 fulltime posi- tions shall be used to establish a Drug En- forcement Administration Drug Education officers program. SEC. 198. FEDERAL BUREAU OF INVESTIGATION DRUG ENFORCEMENT PERSONNEL EN- HANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for salaries and expenses of the Federal Bureau of Investigation for fiscal year 1989, $38,000,000: Provided, That such appropria- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2869 tion shall be in addition to any appropria- tions requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolu- tions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such addi- tional appropriation shall be used to in- crease the number of drug enforcement agents at the Bureau by no less than 400 fulltime equivalent positions over such per- sonnel levels onboard at the Bureau as of September 30, 1988, and for related equip- ment and drug, enforcement operations: Pro- vided further, That of these additional posi- tions, 5 fulltime positions shall be available to establish a Federal Bureau of Investiga- tion Drug Education officers program at the Bureau. SEC. 198A. U.S. MARSHALS SERVICE DRUG EN- FORCEMENT PERSONNEL ENHANCE. MENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for salaries and expenses of the U.S. Marshals Service for the fiscal year 1989, $73,800,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to the Congress on Feb- ruary 18, 1988, or provided in regular appro- priations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional ap- propriation shall be used as follows: (1) $11,500,000 for 230 fulltime equivalent positions for asset seizure and forfeiture ac- tivities; (2) $30,700,000 for 20 fulltime equivalent positions, including $20,000,000 for Coopera- tive Agreement Program renovation project, and $10,000,000 for maintenance of Federal cell block areas with upgraded security equipment; (3) $10,000,000 for 188 fulltime equivalent positions for criminal justice support activi- ties, including prisoner production and transportation; (4) $6,200,000 for 104 fulltime equivalent positions for protection of the Federal judi- ciary and court facilities resulting from in- creased drug-related trials; (5) $4,600,000 for 60 fulltime equivalent positions for increased workloads of the Marshals Service Witness Security Program; and (6) $10,800,000 for 139 fulltime equivalent positions for increased narcotics-related in- vestigation and arrest of fugitives in the United States and foreign countries. SEC. 198B. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS. There is authorized to be appropriated in fiscal year 1989 to the buildings and facili- ties account, Federal Prison System, De- partment of Justice, $200,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used for planning, acquisition of sites, construction of new facilities; pur- chase: leasing and acquisition of facilities and remodeling and equipping of such facili- ties for penal and correctional use, to allevi- ate overcrowding in existing prisons and to meet the increased demand for prison space resulting from drug-related offenses. SEC. 198C. UNITED STATES ATTORNEYS DRUG EN- FORCEMENT PERSONNEL ENHANCE- MENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for salaries and expenses of the United States Attorneys, Department of Justice for fiscal year 1989, $10,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase the number of United States At- torneys, including related support staff by no fewer than 200 fulltime equivalent posi- tions over such personnel levels onboard at the Department of Justice as of September 30, 1988. Subtitle H-Miscellaneous Law Enforcement Provisions SEC. 199. REWARDS FOR FUGITIVE CAPTURE. Section 3059 of title 18, United States Code, is amended by inserting the following new subsection after subsection (b): "(c) There is authorized to be appropri- ated, out of any money in the Treasury not otherwise appropriated, the sum of $10,000 for the capture, or for assisting in or fur- nishing information leading to the capture, of an escaped Federal prisoner under sec- tion 751 of this title, or any person who has violated either section 3146 (bond default), 4213 (parole violation), or 3606 (probation violation), of this title, to be appropriated and expended in the discretion of, and upon such conditions as may be imposed by, either the Director of the United States Marshals Service or the Director of the Bureau of Prisons, as the case may be, pur- suant to regulations promulgated by the At- torney General. Not more than $10,000 shall be expended in connection with the capture of any one person.". SEC. 199A. PROHIBITION OF DANGEROUS WEAPONS IN FEDERAL COURTHOUSES. (a) It shall be unlawful for any person to carry or project into, possess within, or cause to be present within any Federal courthouse any firearm, dangerous weapon, explosive, or incendiary device. (b) Any violation of subsection (a) of this section, or any attempt to commit any such violation, shall be a felony punishable by a fine not exceeding $5,000, or imprisonment not exceeding 5 years, or both. (c) Any firearm, ammunition, dangerous weapon, explosive, or incendiary device in- volved in or used or intended to be used in any violation of the provisions of this sec- tion shall be subject to seizure and forfeit- ure in accordance with all applicable provi- sions of Federal law. (d) Notice to the effect of subsections (a), (b), and (c) of this section shall be posted conspicuously by the United States Marshal at one or more public entrances to each Federal courthouse. (e) Nothing in this section shall interfere with or prevent the exercise by any-court of the United States of its power to punish for contempt; nor shall anything in this section interfere with or limit in any way the power of a court of the United States to promul- gate rules or orders regulating, restricting or prohibiting the possession or carrying of weapons within any building, or upon the grounds appurtenant thereto, housing such court or any of its proceedings. (f) Nothing contained in this section shall be deemed to prohibit or render unlawful any act performed in the lawful discharge of the official duties of a law enforcement officer of the Federal Government or any State or political subdivision thereof. (g) DEFINITIONS.-As used in this section- (1) The term "dangerous weapon" in- cludes all articles enumerated and included within the definition of "dangerous weapon" set forth in section 16(a) of the Act of July 31, 1946 (40 U.S.C. 193m). (2) The term "explosive" shall have the same meaning as when used in section 841 of title 18, United States Code. (3) The term "Federal courthouse" means a building which houses a court of the United States or is the site of a proceeding before a ,judge or court of the United States, a United States Magistrate, a bankruptcy judge, or a Federal grand jury. (4) The term "firearm" shall have the same meaning as when used in section 921(a)(3) of title 18, United States Code. SEC. 199B. SUPPORT OF UNITED STATES PRISONERS IN NON-FEDERAL INSTITUTIONS. Chapter 301 of title 18, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new section: "SEC. 4013. SUPPORT OF UNITED STATES PRISON. ERS IN NON-FEDERAL INSTITUTIONS. "(a) The Attorney General or his desig- nee, in support of United States prisoners in non-Federal Institutions, is authorized to make payments from appropriations avail- able to the United States Marshals Service, without limitation as to fiscal year, for- "(1) necessary clothing; "(2) medical care and necessary guard hire; "(3) payment of rewards for assistance in the capture or information leading to the capture of a Federal fugitive; "(4) the housing, care and security of per- sons held in custody of the U.S. Marshal pursuant to Federal law under agreements with State or local units of government or contracts with private entities; and "(5) entering into contracts or cooperative agreements with any State, territory,. or po- litical subdivision thereof, for the necessary construction, physical renovation, acquisi- tion of equipment, supplies, or materials re- quired to establish acceptable conditions of confinement and detention services in any State or local jurisdiction which agrees to provide guaranteed bed space for Federal detainees within that correctional system, in accordance with regulations issued by the Attorney General and which are compara- ble to the regulations issued under section 4006 of this title, except that amounts made available for this purpose shall not exceed the average per-inmate cost of constructing similar confinement facilities for the Feder- al prison population: And provided further, That the availability of such federally as- sisted facility shall be assured for housing Federal prisoners and the per diem rate charged for housing such Federal prisoners shall not exceed allowable costs or other conditions specified in the contract or coop- erative agreement." SEC. 199C. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS FOR PRESIDENT'S MEDIA COMMIS- SION ON ALCOHOL AND DRUG ABUSE PREVENTION. There are hereby authorized to be appro- priated for the President's Media Commis- sion on Alcohol and Drug Abuse Prevention the following amounts: (1) $1,000,000 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989; (2) $1,000,000 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1990; and (3) $1,000.000 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1991. TITLE II-INTERNATIONAL NARCOTICS CON- TROL AND ASSISTANCE TO FOREIGN COUNTRIES Subtitle A-International Drug Eradication Improvement Program SEC. 201. DRUG SOURCE COUNTRY ERADICATION IMPROVEMENT'ACT OF 198& (a) There is established within the De- partment of State under the Office of Inter- national Narcotics Matters an International Special Operations Drug Eradication Squad- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2870 CONGRESSIONAL. RECORD - SENATE ron (hereafter in this subtitle known as the "Squadron") to be deployed to increase the eradication of drugs in drug source coun- tries. (b) The purpose of the Squadron estab- lished in subsection (a) under this subtitle is- (1) to provide special assistance to drug source countries who request drug eradica- tion assistance from the United States; and (2) to participate in joint international drug eradication operations in drug source countries where one or more of the partici- pating nations have specifically requested the assistance of the United States in such operation. (c) There is authorized to be appropriated for fiscal year 1989, $12,000,000 for the International Narcotics Matters program at the Department of State for the procure- ment of helicopters, fixed wing aircraft, other related equipment; operation and maintenance for such helicopters and air- craft; and salaries and expenses for fulltime personnel of the Squadron established in subsection (a) of this section: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the President in his budget presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or appropri- ated in any regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending on September 30, 1989, or as author- ized in section 230 of subtitle D of this title. (d) The Secretary of State shall establish strict criteria guidelines and procedures which shall govern a decision by the United States to deploy the Squadron established under subsection (a) of this section in sup- port of any drug source nation requesting the assistance of the United States Govern- ment in drug eradication operations. Such criteria shall include, but not limited to, the following: (1) the level of cooperation offered by the drug source country to the United States in eradicating drugs, and- conducting other drug enforcement operations; (2) the record of unilateral action taken by the drug source country to eradicate drugs from their soil; and - (3) the evidence exhibited by such drug source country that it intends to maintain a continuing unilateral drug eradication pro- gram upon completion of the drug eradica- tion operation deploying the Squadron es- tablished in subsection (a) of this section. Subtitle B-International Narcotics Matters Improvement and Special Assistance Programs SEC. 211. ECONOMIC ASSISTANCE INCENTIVE PRO- GRAM. (a) There is established under the Agency for International Development (A.I.D.) a special economic assistance incentive grant program to provide direct, nonmilitary, eco- nomic assistance to drug source countries that meet specific, proscribed coca leaf, marijuana, and opium eradication goals during fiscal years 1989, 1990, and 1991. (b) In order for a drug source country to be eligible for the special economic assist- ance grants authorized in subsection (a), such country must achieve a verifiable 15 percent reduction in the national coca leaf crop acreage, a verifiable 15 percent reduc- tion in the national marijuana crop acreage, and a verifiable 15percent reduction in the national opium crop acreage in the year pre- ceding the first fiscal year for which such grant assistance is authorized, and a verifia- ble- 40 percent reduction in the national coca leaf, marijuana, or opium crop acreage over the period of fiscal year 1989. to fiscal year 1991. Identification of total aggregate .national coca leaf, marijuana, or opium acreage production during a given year, shall be determined by the Drug Enforce- ment Administration of the Department of Justice and shall serve as the baseline from which a country's drug eradication efforts shall be measured. The Drug Enforcement Administration shall also be tasked by the Attorney General of the United States to verify the eradication effort put forth by_ such drug source countries as the basis for determining whether or not such country has met the eligibility requirements for the economic assistance authorized in subsec- tion (a). The Administrator of the Drug En- forcement Administration shall make his as- sessment of baseline drug production and his determinations of drug source country eligibility for economic assistance grants under subsection (a) in a timely fashion and consistent with the best available technolo- gy to determine both the baseline produc- tion levels from which the eradication effort of drug source countries shall be measured, and the verified eradication initiative taken by such drug source countries. Both the baseline production levels and the verifica- tion of drug eradication in drug source countries shall be reported to the appropri- ate committees of the Congress in a timely fashion. (c) There is authorized to be appropriated to the Agency for International Develop- ment for each of the fiscal years 1989, 1990, and 1991, $200,000,000, such amounts to remain available Until expended: Provided, That of this annual amount up to 5 percent per fiscal year may be used for administra- tion of the grant program, including trans- fers to the Drug Enforcement Administra- tion to cover their costs in implementing the program goals and objectives. (d) The Comptroller General of the United States shall monitor the economic assistance Incentive grant program estab- lished under subsection (a) and funded under subsection (c) of this section and report periodically to the Congress regard- ing the management of and allocation of grant funds under the program. (e) At the start of fiscal year 1991, a panel consisting of the Attorney General of the United States or his designee; the Secretary of State; the Director of the Agency for International Development; and appropriate representatives of the House and Senate, designated by the Speaker of the House of Representatives and the Majority Leader of the Senate, respectively, shall be convened by the Director of the Agency for Interna- tional Development to consider whether or not the economic assistance incentive grant program established in this section should be continued beyond fiscal year 1991 and if it is determined that the program should be continued, make legislative and administra- tive recommendations for improvements in the program, Including proposed funding levels for the program in subsequent fiscal years. Subtitle C-Amendments to Foreign Assistance Act of 1961, as amended SEC. 220. AMENDMENTS TO THE FOREIGN ASSIST- ANCE ACT OF 1961. Subsection 481(h)(3) of the Foreign As- sistance Act of 1961 is amended to read as follows: "(3) In making the certification required by paragraph (2) of this subsection, the President shall consider whether such gov- ernment- "(A) has taken actions that have resulted in maximum reductions in illicit drug pro- duction which were determined to be achievable pursuant to subsection (e)(4); "(B) has taken the legal and law enforce- ment measures to enforce in its territory, to the maximum extent possible, the elimina- tion of illicit cultivation and the suppression of illicit manufacture of and traffic in nar- March 23, 1988 cotic and psychotropic drugs and other con- trolled substances, as evidenced by seizures of such drugs and substances significantly affecting the United States; "(C) has taken the legal and law enforce- went steps necessary to eliminate, to the maximum extent possible, the laundering in that country of drug-related profits or drug- related monies, as evidenced by- "(I) the enactment and enforcement of laws- prohibiting such conduct, "(ii) the willingness of such government to enter into mutual legal assistance agree- ments with the United States governing (but not limited to) money laundering, and "(iii) the degree to which such govern- ment otherwise cooperates with United States law enforcement authorities on anti- money laundering efforts; . "(D) as a matter of government policy, en- courages or facilitates the production or dis- tribution of illegal drugs; "(E) consists of any senior official who en- gages In, encourages, or facilitates the pro- duction or distribution of illegal drugs; "(F) has investigated aggressively all cases in which any member of an agency of the United States Government engaged in drug enforcement activities since January 1, 1985, has suffered or been threatened with vio- lence, inflicted by or with the complicity of any law enforcement or other officer of such country or any political subdivision thereof, and has energetically sought to bring the perpetrators of such offense or of- fenses to justice; and "(G) having been requested to do so by the United States Government, fails to pro- vide reasonable cooperation to lawful activi- ties of United States drug enforcement agents, Including the refusal of permission to such agents engaged in interdiction of aerial smuggling into the United States to pursue suspected aerial smugglers a reason- able distance into the airspace of the re- quested country. The International Narcotics Control Strate- gy Report shall describe for each country listed under subparagraphs (D) through (G) the activities and identities of officials whose activities caused such country to be so listed.". Subtitle D-International Narcotics Matters Authorization of Appropriations SEC. 230. AUTHORIZATIONS OF APPROPRIATIONS. Section 482(a) of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 is amended by striking out para- graphs (1) and (3) and by inserting the fol- lowing new paragraph (1) after "(a)": "(1) To carry out the purposes of section 481, there are authorized to be appropriated to the President $138,000,000 for fiscal year 1989 and $150,000,000 for fiscal year 1990.". SEC. 231. DEVELOPMENT OF HERBICIDES FOR AERIAL COCA ERADICATION. The Secretary of State shall use not less than $500,000 of the funds made available for fiscal year 1989 to carry out chapter 8 of part I of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 (relating to international narcotics control) to finance research on and the development and testing of safe and effective herbicides for use in the aerial eradication of. coca. SEC. 232. PROCUREMENT OF WEAPONS TO DEFEND AIRCRAFT INVOLVED IN NARCOTICS .CONTROL EFFORTS. (a) Of the funds available to carry out chapter 2 of part II of the Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961 (relating to grant military assistance), $900,000 for each of the fiscal years 1989 and 1990 shall be made available to arm, for defensive purposes, aircraft used in narcotic control eradication or interdic- tion efforts. These funds may only be used to arm aircraft already in the inventory of Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE the recipient country, and may not be used for the purchase of new aircraft. (b) The Committee on Foreign Affairs of the House of Representatives and the Com- mittee on Foreign Relations of the Senate shall be notified of the use of any such funds for that purpose at least 15 days in advance in accordance with the reprogram- ming procedures applicable under section 634A of the Foreign Assistance Act of.1961. SEC. 233. PILOT AND AIRCRAFT MAINTENANCE TRAINING FOR NARCOTICS CONTROL ACTIVITIES. (a) Not less than $2,000,000 of the funds made available for each of the fiscal years 1989 and 1990 to carry out chapter 5 of part II of the Foreign Assistance Act (relating, to international military education and train- ing) shall be available only for- (1) education and training in the oper- ation and maintenance of equipment used in narcotics control interdiction and eradica- tion efforts for countries in Latin America and the Caribbean; and (2) the expenses of deploying, upon the re- quest of the government of a foreign coun- try, Department of Defense mobile training teams in that foreign country to conduct training in military-related individuals and collective skills that will enhance that coun- try's ability to conduct tactical operations In narcotics interdiction. (b) Assistance under this section shall be coordinated with assistance provided under chapter 8 of part I of that Act (relating to international narcotics control). (c) Assistance may be provided pursuant to this section notwithstanding the prohibi- tion contained in section 660 of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 (relating to police SEC. 234. REALLOCATION OF FUNDS WITHHELD FROM COUNTRIES WHICH FAIL TO TAKE ADEQUATE STEPS TO HALT IL- LICIT DRUG PRODUCTION OR TRAF. FICKING. (a) Chapter 8 of part I of the Foreign As- sistance Act of 1961 is amended by adding at the end the following: `SEC. 486. REALLOCATION OF FUNDS WITHHELD FROM COUNTRIES WHICH FAIL TO TAKE ADEQUATE STEPS TO HALT IL- LICIT DRUG. PRODUCTION OR TRAF- FICKING. "(a) ADDITIONAL ASSISTANCE FOR COUN- TRIES TAKING SIGNIFICANT STEPS.-If any funds authorized to be appropriated for any fiscal year for security assistance are not used for assistance for the country for which those funds were allocated because of the requirements of section 481(h) or any other provision of law requiring the with- holding of assistance for countries that have not taken adequate steps to halt illicit drug production or trafficking, the President shall use those funds for additional assist- ance for those countries which have met their illicit drug eradication targets or have otherwise taken significant steps to halt il- licit drug production or trafficking, as fol- lows: "(1) INTERNATIONAL NARCOTICS CONTROL AS- sIsTANCE.-Those funds may be transferred to and consolidated with the funds appro- priated to carry out this chapter in order to provide additional narcotics control assist- ance for those countries. Funds transferred under this paragraph may only be used to provide increased funding for activities pre- viously justified to the Congress. Transfers may be made under this paragraph without regard to the 20-percent increase limitation contained in section 610(a). This paragraph does not apply with respect to funds made available for assistance under the Arms Export Control Act. "(2) SECURITY ASSISTANCE.-Any such funds not used under paragraph (1) shall be reprogrammed within the account for which they were appropriated (subject to the regu- lar reprogramming procedures under sec- tion 634A) in order to provide additional se- curity assistance for those countries. "(b) DEFINITION OF SECURITY ASSIST- ANCE.-A5 used in this section, the term 'se- curity assistance' means assistance under chapter 2 of part II of this Act (relating to the military assistance program), chapter 4 of part II of this Act (relating to the Eco- nomic Support Fund), chapter 5 of part II of this Act (relating to international mili- tary education and training), or the Arms Export Control Act (relating to foreign mili- tary sales credits).". (b) The amendment made by subsection (a) does not apply with respect to funds ap- propriated prior to the date of enactment of this Act. SEC. 235. ASSISTANCE FOR BOLIVIA. For fiscal year 1989, assistance may be provided for Bolivia under chapter 2 (relat- ing to grant military assistance), chapter 4 (relating to the economic support fund), and chapter 5 (relating to international military education and training) of part II of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 and under chapter 2 of the Arms Export Control Act (relating to foreign military sales financing) only if the President certifies to the Con- gress that the Government of Bolivia has enacted legislation that will- (1) establish its legal coca requirements, (2) provide for the licensing of the number of hectares necessary to produce. the legal requirement, (3) make unlicensed coca production ille- gal, and (4) make possession and distribution of coca leaf illegal (other than for licit pur- poses). SEC. 236. ASSISTANCE FOR MEXICO. (a) Of the "amounts made available for each of the fiscal years 1989 and 1990 to carry out chapter 8 of part I of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 (relating to interna- tional narcotics control), not more than $20,000,000 may be made available for Mexico. (b) Of the funds allocated for assistance for Mexico for each of those fiscal years under that chapter, $1,000,000 shall be with- held from expenditure until the President reports to the Congress that the Govern- ment of Mexico- (1) has fully investigated the 1985 mur- ders of Drug Enforcement Administration agent Enrique Camarena Salazar and his pilot Alfredo Zavala Avelar; (2) has fully investigated the 1986 deten- tion and torture of Drug Enforcement Ad- ministration agent Victor Cortez, Junior; and (3) has brought to trial and is effectively prosecuting those responsible for those murders and those responsible for that de- tention and torture. SEC. 237. COOPERATIVE NONMAJOR DRUG-TRANSIT COUNTRIES. (a) The Congress directs the Assistant Secretary of State for International Narcot- ics Matters to give greater attention, and provide more narcotics control assistance, to those countries which are drug-transit coun- tries but are not major drug-transit coun- tries (as defined in section 481(i)(5) of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961) and which are cooperating with the United States in its international narcotics control efforts. (b) Of the amounts made available for each of the fiscal years 1989 and 1990 to carry out chapter 8 of part I of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 (relating to interna- tional narcotics control), not less than $5,000,000 shall be available only for assist- S 2871 ante to countries described in subsection (a). SEC. 238. INCREASED FUNDING FOR AID DRUG EDU- CATION PROGRAMS. ' In addition to amounts otherwise author- ized to be appropriated, there are author- ized to be appropriated to the President $1,000,000 for each of the fiscal years 1989 and 1990 to carry out chapter 1 of part I of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 (relating to development assistance), which amount shall be used pursuant to section 126(b)(2) of that Act for additional activities aimed at increasing awareness of the effects of pro- duction and trafficking of illicit narcotics on source and transit countries. SEC. 239. DEVELOPMENT OF MODEL TREATIES AND COMPREHENSIVE ANTIDRUG LAWS. The Secretary of State and the Attorney General shall jointly develop a model extra- dition treaty with respect to narcotics-relat- ed violations (including extradition of host country nationals), a model mutual legal as- sistance treaty, and model comprehensive anti-narcotics legislation. The Secretary of State shall distribute such treaties and leg- islation to each United States mission abroad: The Secretary of State shall report to the Congress, not later than six months after the date of enactment of this Act, on actions taken to carry out this section. SEC. 240. REPORTING ON TRANSFER OF UNITED STATES ASSETS. Any transfer by the United States Gov- ernment to a foreign country for narcotics control purposes of any property seized by - or otherwise forfeited to the United States Government in connection with narcotics related criminal activity shall be subject to the regular reprogramming procedures ap- plicable under section 634A of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961. At the end of each fiscal year, the President shall submit a report to the Congress of all such transfers during that fiscal year, including an esti- mate of the fair market value and physical condition of each item of property trans- ferred. SEC. 241. IMPORTANCE OF SUPPRESSING INTERNA- TIONAL. NARCOTICS TRAFFICKING. Section 481(a)(1) of the Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961 is amended- (1) by redesignating subparagraphs (B) through (D) as subparagraphs (C) through (E), respectively; and (2) by inserting after subparagraph (A) the following: "(B) suppression of international narcot- ics trafficking is among the most important foreign policy objectives of the United States:". SEC. 242. INFORMATION FROM OTHER AGENCIES IN ANNUAL NARCOTICS CONTROL RE-. PORTS. Section 481(e)(3) of the Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961 is amended by adding after subparagraph (D) the following: "(E) A section prepared .by the Drug En- forcement Administration, a section pre- pared by the Customs Service, and a section prepared by the Coast Guard, which de- scribes in detail- "(I) the assistance provided or to be pro- vided (as the case may be) to such country by that agency, and - "(ii) the assistance provided or to be pro- vided (as the case may be) to that agency by such country, with respect to narcotic control efforts during the preceding fiscal year, the current fiscal year, and the next fiscal year.". SEC. 243. EXPRESSION IN NUMERICAL. TERMS OF MAXIMUM ACHIEVABLE REDUCTIONS IN ILLICIT DRUG PRODUCTION. Section 481(e)(4) of the Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961 is amended by inserting Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2872 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE after the second sentence the following: "Each determination of the President under the preceding sentence shall be expressed in numerical terms, such as the number of acres of illicitly cultivated controlled sub- stances which can be eradicated.". SEC.'244. REPORTS ON ASSISTANCE DENIED. Section 481(e) of the Foreign Assistance Act of 1961 is amended by adding at the end the following: "(7) Each report pursuant to this subsec- tion shall describe the United States assist- ance for the preceding fiscal year which was denied, pursuant to subsection (h), to each major illicit drug producing country and each major drug-transit country.". Subtitle E-Latin American Antidrug Strike Force SEC. 250. SENSE OF THE CONGRESS. It is the sense of Congress that- (1) the operations of International illegal drug smuggling organizations pose a direct threat to the national security of the member states of the Organization of Amer- ican States; (2)-illegal international drug smuggling or- ganizations have grown so large and power- ful that they threaten to overwhelm small nations standing alone against them; (3) to preserve the national sovereignty, protect the public health, and maintain do- mestic law and order within their borders, member states of the Organization of Amer- ican States should coordinate their efforts to fight the illegal drug trade; (4) recent events in drug source and tran- sit countries in the Western Hemisphere make clear the requirement for internation- al agreement on the formation of a multina- tional strike force intended to conduct oper- ations against these Illegal drug smuggling organizations; (5) the United States should make every effort to initiate diplomatic discussions through the Organization of American States or through other. bilateral. or multi- lateral fora aimed at achieving agreement to establish and operate the Latin American Antidrug Strike Force; and (6) sensitive to the legitimate concerns of other member states of the Organization of American States, the United States stands ready to provide equipment, training, and fi- nancial resources to support the establish- ment and operation of this Strike Force, but believes that Strike Force personnel should' be provided by those states facing the most serious threat from drug trafficking organi- zations. SEC. 251: DEPARTMENT OF STATE. (a) In the Office of Secretary of State, the position of Ambassador at Large and Coor- dinator for Western Hemisphere Antidrug Efforts is created. The Ambassador shall be appointed by the President, with the advice and consent of the Senate, and shall be the principal advisor to the Secretary regarding United States antidrug efforts In the West- ern Hemisphere. (b)(1) The Ambassador at Large, under the direction of the Secretary of State, shall coordinate the efforts of all United States bureaus and agencies involved In antidrug efforts and subject to the authority of the Chief of Diplomatic Mission in all foreign states in the Western Hemisphere, with spe- cial emphasis on those activities which cross one or more national borders. (2) The Ambassador shall from time to time report on the effectiveness of the oper- ations of and the level of cooperation among these United States bureaus and agencies involved in antidrug efforts to the Secretary of State and to the Chairman of the National Drug Policy Board. (3) The Ambassador at Large shall be a member of all interagency groups below the cabinet level with authority or oversight over United States international drug policy or operations. (c)(1) The Ambassador at Large shall un- dertake, under the direction of the Secre- tary of State, diplomatic discussions with member states of the Organization of Amer- ican States aimed at securing agreement to the formation of a multinational strike force intended to conduct operations against international illegal drug trafficking organi- zations wherever they may be found In the Western Hemisphere. (2) The multinational strike force shall be established by treaty or executive agree- ment among the participating states. (3) The Ambassador at Large shall seek to secure participation in the strike force by those Western Hemisphere states most threatened by international illegal drug trafficking organizations. (4) Recognizing the urgency of the situa- tion, efforts to obtain agreement to the es- tablishment of the strike force should be the immediate focus of a priority effort by the Ambassador at Large. (5) Not later than six months after the Ambassador at Large assumes office, the Secretary of State shall report to the Com- mittee on Foreign Relations of the Senate and the Committee on Foreign Affairs of the House of Representatives on the progress United States diplomatic efforts have made toward achieving agreement on the establishment of the multinational strike force. SEC. 252. DEPARTMENT OF DEFENSE. (a)(1) The Secretary of Defense shall de- velop a plan for the establishment, training, equipping, and operation of a multinational strike force for operations against interna- tional drug trafficking organizations wher- ever they are found outside the United States and Its territories In the Western Hemisphere. (2) The Joint Chiefs of Staff, in consulta- tion with the Commander, United States Southern Command, shall develop a table of organization and equipment for a mu)tina- .tional strike force sized and equipped to deal with any combination of armed resist- ance any Western Hemisphere international illegal drug trafficking organization could offer to any combination of drug eradica- tion, drug interdiction, or criminal appre- hension operations the strike force could be called upon to undertake anywhere in the -Western Hemisphere. (3) For planning purposes, the multina- tional strike. force shall be equipped entirely with United - States-produced military or commercially available equipment. (4) The Joint Chiefs of Staff shall develop a plan for employment of this strike force to eradicate the major coca and marijuana crop concentrations in the Western Hemi- sphere, to interdict the major international transportation corridors through which the illegal drug traffic moves, and to arrest the members of the major international drug trafficking organizations involved in produc- ing, transporting, and distributing illegal drugs in the Western Hemisphere, as part of coordinated operations designed to drasti- cally and immediately reduce the supply of cocaine, opium, and marijuana on the inter- national market. (b)(1) The Secretary of Defense shall de- velop budget-quality estimates of the cost of establishing, equipping, training, and oper- ating the strike force planned for under sub- section (a) above for the balance of fiscal year 1989; for fiscal year 1990; and for fiscal year 1991. (2) The Secretary of Defense shall identi- fy equipment and supplies in the United States inventory which can be provided to March 23, 1988 this strike force pursuant to the table of or- ganization and equipment developed by the Joint Chiefs of Staff under subsection (a) above. (3) The Secretary of Defense shall identi- fy training resources in the United States which will be necessary to properly train the strike force, shall develop schedules for training the national strike force developed by the Joint Chiefs of Staff under subsec- tion (a) above, and shall develop cost esti- mates for transporting, training, and hous- ing strike force personnel and their depend- ents in conjunction with their training. (4) The cost estimates and plans devel- oped under section 252 of this subtitle shall be provided to the Committees on the Budget, the Committees on Armed Services and the Committees on Appropriations, of the Senate and the House of Representa- tives, and the Select Committee on Narcot- ics Abuse and Control of the House of Rep- resentatives, and the Senate International Narcotics Control Caucus not later than ninety days after the enactment of this sub- title into law. (c) The Assistant Secretary of Defense for International Security Affairs shall develop a plan for funding and supporting the mul- tinational strike force developed under sub- section. (a) through the Defense Security Assistance Agency. (d) Within 120 days of enactment of this Act, the President of the United States shall submit to Congress a supplemental budget request for the fiscal year ending Septem- ber 30, 1989, covering the cost of operation and maintenance of the Latin American Strike Force established in this subtitle for the balance of the fiscal year: Provided fur- ther, That such supplemental budget re- quest shall be consistent with the cost esti- mates mandated under subsection (b)(1) of this section. TITLE III-DRUG INTERDICTION ASSET IMPROVEMENT AND ENHANCEMENT SEC. 301. SHORT TITLE. This title may be cited as the "National Drug Interdiction Asset Improvement and Enhancement Act of 1988". _ Subtitle A-Coast Guard SEC. 310. COAST GUARD DRUG INTERDICTION EN- HANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Acquisition, Construction, and Improvement expenses of the Coast Guard for fiscal year 1989, $186,000,000: Provided, That such ap- propriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, -1989: Provided further, That such appropriation authorized under this subtitle shall be allocated only for procure- ment of marine and air drug interdiction assets, including long-range AEW surveil- lance aircraft, and operation and mainte- nance expenses of the Coast Guard. Subtitle B-United States Customs Service SEC. 320. UNITED STATES CUSTOMS SERVICE DRUG INTERDICTION ENHANCEMENT. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated for Operation and Maintenance, Air Inter- diction Program for fiscal year 1989, $110,000,000: Provided, That such appro- priation shall be In addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be avail- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March ,23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE able for the procurement of helicopters; air detection, tracking, and interceptor aircraft; command, control, communications, and in- telligence (C3I) upgrades for joint Customs- Coast Guard and other C31 centers under construction; and operation and mainte- nance expenses for these and other assets of the United States Customs Service's air interdiction program. (b) There is authorized to be appropriated for salaries and expenses for fiscal year 1989, $15,000,000: Provided, That such ap- propriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal. year.1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used for the procurement, operation, and mainte- nance of marine interdiction vessels, and joint command centers, evaluations of new marine detection technologies, and other marine interdiction assets of the United States Customs Service. Subtitle C-Department of Defense Drug Interdiction Assistance . - This subtitle may be cited as the "Depart- ment of Defense Drug Interdiction Assist- ance Act of 1988". SEC. 331. AUTHORIZATION. (a) Funds are hereby authorized to be ap- propriated to the Department of Defense for fiscal year 1989 for enhancement of drug interdiction assistance activities of the De- partment as follows: (1) for procurement of four radar aeros- tats, $75,000,000; (2) for operation and maintenance of E- 2C, E-3, and other aircraft surveillance; de- tection; and flight hour support for drug interdiction purposes only, $15,000,000; and (3) for operation, maintenance, refurbish- ment, and support of existing surplus De- partment of Defense aircraft, helicopters, and other assets to be used to support re- quests for assistance by cooperating, drug source countries, as outlined in title II, sub- title E of this Act, $10,000,000. (b) The funds authorized to be appropri- ated in subsection (a) of this section shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on Febru- ary 18, 1988, or provided in regular appro- priations Acts or' continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989. (c)(1) The Secretary of Defense shall make the radar aerostats acquired under subsection (a)(1) available to the appropri- ate Federal law enforcement agency or agencies of the United States, as designated by the National Drug Policy Board estab- lished by the National Narcotics Act of 1984. (2) The radar aerostats shall be made available to agencies under this subsection subject to the provisions of chapter 18 of title 10, United States Code. Subtitle D-Drug Enforcement Administration SEC. 341. DRUG ENFORCEMENT ADMINISTRATION INTERDICTION ENHANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses of-theDrug Enforce- ment Administration for fiscal year 1989, $48,000,000: Provided, That such appropria- tion shall be in addition to any appropria- tions requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to the Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided 'further, That such additional appropriation shall be used for. the establishment of an International Drug Interdiction helicopter force within the Drug Enforcement Administration to be utilized in joint drug interdiction oper- ations, similar in scope and design to OPBAT, in the Bahamas and other drug source and transhipment countries that have authorized the use of joint operations featuring United States and host country law enforcement personnel in such coun- tries for drug interdiction purposes: Provid- ed, That the Administrator of the Drug En- forcement Administration shall coordinate the establishment and deployment of this International Drug Interdiction helicopter force with the Secretary of State; the Attor- ney General of the United States; the Secre- tary of the Treasury, the Secretary of Transportation, and any other law enforce- ment agencies of the United States with on- going drug interdiction programs: Provided further, That of the appropriation author- ized under this subsection, $4,000,000 shall be allocated for the enhancement of the El Paso Intelligence Center (EPIC) to provide more tactical intelligence to the Drug En- forcement Administration and all other United States drug enforcement and inter- diction agencies. Subtitle E-Immigration and Naturalization Service/Border Patrol SEC. 351. BORDER PATROL DRUG INTERDICTION ENHANCEMENT. There is authorized to be appropriated for Salaries and Expenses of the Border Patrol within the Department of Justice for fiscal year 1989, $20,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or pro- vided in regular appropriations Acts or con- tinuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided fur- ther, That such additional appropriation shall be used only for procurement of drug interdiction-related equipment for Border Patrol drug enforcement personnel, includ- ing spare parts for helicopters; 4-wheel drive law enforcement vehicles; and initial pro- curement of mobile sensor response system and electronic Intrusion detection, and for related operation and maintenance ex- penses. Subtitle F-Establishment of Interagency South- west Border Drug Interdiction Mobile Corridor Task Force - SEC. 361. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS. (a) There is established an Interagency Southwest Border Drug Interdiction Mobile Corridor Task Force, consisting of drug en- forcement officers of the 'United States Border Patrol, United States Customs Serv- ice, and the United States Drug Enforce- ment Administration. Such interagency task force shall consist of 100 full-time positions of the United States Border Patrol; 25 full- time positions of the United States Customs Service; and 25 full-time positions of the United States Drug Enforcement Adminis- tration. - (b) - The full-time positions identified in subsection (a) shall be used to establish 2 mobile corridor operations units to be de- ployed along the southwest border between the ports of entry. (c) The purpose of the task force estab- lished in subsection (a) of this section is- (1) to conduct joint drug interdiction oper- ations between the ports of entry along the southwest border of the United States, from Texas to California; (2) to assist and augment other law en- forcement agencies personnel along the southwest border in the interdiction of ille- gal drugs and arrest of narcotics traffickers; and S 2873 (3) to assist State and local law enforce- ment officials along the southwest border of the United States in the interdiction of ille- gal drugs and the"- arrest of narcotics traf- fickers. (d) There is authorized to be appropriated for fiscal year 1989, $15,000,000 to-?.16ie De- partment of Justice for the salaries and ex- penses of the task force established in sub- section (a) of this section, including reim- bursement for expenses incurred by State and local law enforcement agencies in joint operations conducted with the task force. Such amount authorized to be appropriated, shall be in addition to any appropriations provided for the United States Customs Service and the United States Border Patrol, and the Drug Enforcement Adminis- tration in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989, or as authorized in this Act. (e) The Secretary of the Treasury, the At- torney General of the United States, or their designees, shall establish a joint com- mand structure necessary to assure com- plete cooperation and coordination in carry- ing out the duties and mission of the task force established by this section. (f) The joint commanders of the task force established under this section shall make regular written reports to the appro- priate committees of the Congress regarding the specific operations and expenditures of the task force. Subtitle G-United States-Bahamas Drug Interdiction Task Force SEC. 362. REAUTHORIZATION OF UNITED STATES. BAHAMAS DRUG INTERDICTION TASK FORCE PROGRAMS. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated for the United States-Bahamas Drug Inter- diction Task Force established by section 3301 of subtitle E of title III of the Antidrug Abuse Act of 1986 (21 U.S.C. 801 note) for fiscal year 1989, in addition to any other amounts authorized to be appropriated in this title, $13,000,000 for the following: (1) $11,000,000 for procurement, oper- ation, and maintenance of additional marine interdiction vessels; - (2) $1,000,000 for improvement of commu- nications, command and control, and intelli- gence capabilities for. the Task Force; and (3) $1,000,000 to increase drug enforce- ment training for Bahamian law enforce- ment personnel. (b) The Attorney General of the United States shall continue to report to the appro- priate committees of Congress on a quarter- ly basis regarding the progress of the United States-Bahamas Drug Interdiction Task Force. (c) Programs authorized by this section may be carried out only with the concur- rence of the Secretary of State. Subtitle II-Special Drug Interdiction Support SEC. 372. SPECIAL ASSISTANCE TO PUERTO RICO. There is authorized to be appropriated to the Government of Puerto Rico, through the Department of the Treasury, "Payment to the Government of Puerto Rico" grant program for- fiscal year 1989, $7,000,000: Provided, That such amount shall be in ad- dition to any appropriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in -regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used for the procurement of air and marine drug interdiction aircraft; vessels; and for related drug interdiction operation and maintenance purposes. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 S 2874 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -- SENATE SEC. 373. SPECIAL ASSISTANCE TO JAMAICA. There is authorized to be appropriated to the Government of Jamaica, through exist- ing or new grant mechanisms under the au- thority of the Secretary of State for fiscal year 1989, $7,000,000: Provided, That such amount shall be in addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year_ ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used for the procurement of air and marine drug interdiction equipment, including radar, and for related drug interdiction operation and maintenance purposes. SEC. 374. SPECIAL ASSISTANCE TO THE DOMINICAN REPUBLIC. There is authorized to be appropriated to the Government of the Dominican Republic for fiscal year 1989, through existing or new grant mechanisms under the authority of the Secretary of State, $5,000,000: Provided, That such amount shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the Presi- dent in his fiscal year 1989 budget as pre- sented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided fur- ther, That such additional appropriation shall be used only for the procurement of air and marine drug interdiction equipment, including radar, and for related drug inter- diction operation and maintenance pur- poses. SEC. 375. SPECIAL ASSISTANCE TO HAWAII. There is authorized to be appropriated through the Drug Enforcement Administra- tion to the State of Hawaii for fiscal year 1989, $7,000,000: Provided, That such amount shall be in addition to any appro- priations -requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used only for the procurement of air and marine drug interdiction and eradication equip- ment, including aircraft and radar, and for related drug interdiction and eradication op- eration and maintenance purposes. SEC. 376. REPORTING REQUIREMENTS FOR RECIPI- ENTS OF SPECIAL ASSISTANCE SUP- PORT. The Federal departments or agencies pro- viding grants for special drug interdiction assistance authorized. under this subtitle shall make periodic written reports to the appropriate committees of Congress regard- ing the status of the procurement of re- sources and related operation and mainte- nance expenditures authorized under this subtitle. TITLE IV-DEMAND REDUCTION Subtitle A-Treatment and Rehabilitation SEC. 401. AMENDMENTS TO PUBLIC HEALTH SERV- ICE ACT. (a) Section 516(a)(1) of the Public Health Service Act (42 U.S.C. 290ce-1) is amended (1) by striking out "and" at the end of clause (A); (2) by striking out the semicolon and the word "and" at the end of clause (B) and inserting in lieu thereof a comma and the word "and"; and (3) by inserting imme- diately after clause (B) the following: "(C) the treatment and rehabilitation of drug dependent offenders who could other- wise be subject to incarceration; and". (b) Section 516(b) of such Act is'amended by inserting immediately before the period at the end thereof the following: "or mental illness". (c) Section 516(c) of such Act is amended by striking out "No" and inserting in lieu thereof "Except in the case of grants pursu- ant to subsection (a)(1)(C), no". (d) Section 516 of such Act is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new subsection: "(d)(1) For purposes of subsection (a)(1)(C), grants or contracts awarded pur- suant thereto shall emphasize the develop- ment, improvement or expansion of commu- nity based residential treatment services such as therapeutic communities and half- way houses and other programs which can provide treatment alternatives to incarcer- ation. "(2) Such grants or contracts may include funds to purchase or improve land, and to purchase, construct or permanently improve any building or other facility. , "(3) For purposes of this subsection, the term `therapeutic community' means a stratified community composed of peer groups offering a systematic approach to achieve its main rehabilitative objective, which is guided by an explicit perspective on the drug abuse disorder, the client, and recovery." (e) Section 517 of such Act is amended by designating the existing text thereof as sub- section (a) and adding at the end thereof the following new subsection: "(b) There is authorized to be appropri- ated to carry out subsection (a)(1)(C) of this section, $20,000,000 for each of the fiscal years 1989, 1990, and 1991.". Subtitle B-Alcohol and Drug Abuse Treatment and Rehabilitation SEC. 410. SHORT TITLE REFERENCE. This subtitle may be cited as the "Alcohol and Drug Abuse Treatment and Rehabilita- tion Improvement Act of 1988". SEC. 411. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS FOR ALCOHOL AND DRUG ABUSE TREATMENT, FISCAL YEAR 1989, FISCAL YEAR 1990, FISCAL YEAR 1991. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated $558,860,000 for the basic Alcohol, Drug Abuse and Mental Health Bloc Grant Pro- gram as contained in part B of title 19 of the Public Health Services Act (42 U.S.C. 300x, et seq.), for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided, That of this amount no less than 49 per centum shall be available for alcohol and drug abuse pro- grams. (b) There is authorized to be appropriated $600,000,000 for substance abuse emergency drug treatment programs for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided, That these emergency substance abuse drug treatment funds shall be targeted to those States and communities where the sub- stance abuse problem is most acute, based on the best available data of the Alcohol, Drug Abuse, Mental Health Administration (ADAMHA). (c) For the fiscal year ending September .30, 1990, there Is authorized to be appropri- ated $583,000,000 for the basic Alcohol, Drug Abuse, and Mental Health Bloc Grant Program as contained in part B of title 19 of the Public Health Services Act (42 U.S.C. 300x, et seq.): Provided, That of this amount no less than 49 per centum shall be made available for alcohol and drug abuse treatment and rehabilitation programs. (d) For the fiscal year ending September 30, 1990, there is authorized to be appropri- ated $625,000,000 for Substance Abuse Emergency Drug Treatment Programs as contained in part C of title 19 of the Public Health Services Act (42 U.S.C. 300y): Pro- vided, That these emergency substance abuse drug treatment funds shall be target- ed to those States and communities within those States where the substance abuse March 23, 1988 problem is most acute, based on the best available data of the Alcohol, Drug Abuse. Mental Health Administration (ADAMHA) for the most recent calendar year. (e) For the fiscal year ending September 30, 1991, there is authorized to be appropri- ated, $608,000,000 for such basic Alcohol, Drug Abuse and Mental Health Bloc Grant Program: Provided, That of this amount no less than 49 per centum shall be made avail- able for alcohol and drug abuse treatment and rehabilitation programs. (f) For the fiscal year ending September 30, 1991, there is authorized to, be appropri- ated, $650,000,000 for such Substance Abuse Emergency Drug Treatment Programs: Pro- vided, That these emergency substance abuse drug treatment funds shall be-target- ed to those States, and communities within those States, where the substance abuse problem is most acute, based on the best available data of the Alcohol, Drug Abuse, Mental Health Administration (ADAMHA) for the most recent calendar year. SEC. 412: REQUIREMENT FOR STATES TO DEVELOP STATEWIDE SUBSTANCE ABUSE TREATMENT FACILITIES PLANS. All States eligible to receive basic and emergency Alcohol, Drug Abuse, Mental Health Administration bloc grants shall de- velop Statewide substance abuse treatment facilities plans and are hereby authorized to expend up to 1.5 percent of their basic and emergency bloc grant allocations for the de- velopment and preparation of such State- wide plans. SEC. 413. AUTHORIZATION FOR USE OF BLOC GRANT FUNDS FOR ACQUISITION. CONSTRUCTION, AND/OR RENOVA. TION OF DRUG TREATMENT AND RE- HABILITATION FACILITIES. Any State eligible to receive such basic and emergency bloc grants referred to in section 412 is authorized to use up to 40 per centum" of its basic and emergency bloc grant allocations for the acquisition, con- struction, or renovation of substance abuse treatment facilities determined to be needed in such State as identified in the Statewide substance abuse treatment facilities plans required under section 412 of this subtitle. Subtitle C-Amendments to the Drug-Free Schools and Communities Act SEC. 421: DRUG-FREE SCHOOLS REAUTHORIZATION. Section 4111(a) of the Drug-Free Schools and Communities Act of 1986 (hereafter in this title referred to as the "Act") is amend- ed to read as follows: "(a) There are authorized to be appropri- ated $250,000,000 for fiscal year 1988, $300,000,000 for fiscal year. 1989, $350,000,000 for fiscal year 1990, and $350,000,000 for fiscal year 1991 to carry out the provisions of this Act.". SEC. 422. STATE PROGRAM-LOCAL ALLOTMENTS. The second sentence of section 4124(a) of the Act is amended by striking out "the rel- ative numbers of children in the school-age population within such areas" and inserting in lieu thereof "the relative enrollments in public and private, nonprofit schools within the areas served by such agencies". SEC. 423. STATE PROGRAM-PARTICIPATION OF TEACHERS IN PRIVATE NONPROFIT SCHOOLS. Section 4143(b) of the Act is amended by striking out "State, State educational agency, or State agency for higher educa- tion" and inserting in lieu thereof "State, agency, or consortium". SEC. 424. STATE PROGRAM-LOCAL APPLICATIONS. Section 4126(a)(2) of the Act is amended- (1) by redesignating subparagraphs (D) through (J) as subparagraphs (G) through (M), respectively; and Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2875 (2) by inserting after subparagraph (C) the following new subparagraphs: "(D) describe the extent and nature of the current illegal drug and alcohol problem in each school of the applicant, including de- tailed information that shows- "(I) the number or percentage of students who use drugs or alcohol; "(ii) the grade level of those students; "(iii) the types of drugs they use; and "(iv) how the applicant obtained this in- formation; "(E) describe the applicant's drug and al- cohol policy, including an explanation of- "(I) the disciplinary practices and proce- dures it will strictly enforce to eliminate the sale or use of drugs and alcohol on school premises; and "(ii) how it will convey to students the message that drug use is not permissible; "(F) describe how the applicant will moni- tor the effectiveness of its program;". (b) Section 4126 of the Act is further amended by adding at the end thereof the following new subsection: "(b)(1) In order to receive funds under this Act for the third year of its plan, an ap- plicant shall submit to the State education- al agency a progress report on the first 2 fiscal years of its plan. The progress report shall describe in detail- "(A) the applicant's significant accom- plishments under the plan during the pre- ceding 2 years; and "(B) the extent to which the original ob- jectives of the plan are being achieved, in- cluding the extent to which there has been a reduction in the number of students who use drugs and alcohol. "(2) The State educational agency shall not award funds under this Act to an appli- cant for the third year of its plan unless the State educational agency determines that the applicant's progress report shows that it is making reasonable progress toward ac- complishing the objectives of its plan and the purposes of this Act. If the State educa- tional agency determines that reasonable progress is not being made, the State educa- tional agency shall instruct the applicant in writing to modify its plan so as to provide reasonable assurance of such progress. If after 90 days the applicant has not submit- ted to the. State educational agency a modi- fied plan which provides such assurance, the State educational agency may reallocate the applicant's funds to other applicants on the basis of need.". SEC. 425. STATE PROGRAM-REPORTS. Part 2 of the Act is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new section: "SEC. 4127. STATE REPORTS. "Each State shall submit to the Secretary an annual report, at such time and in such form as the Secretary may prescribe, that contains information on the State or local programs the State conducts under this sub- title, Including- "(1) data on the number and characteris- tics of program recipients and the persons who participated in their programs; and "(2) an assessment of the degree to which those programs accomplished their goals, in- cluding their impact upon drug and alcohol use by students.". SEC. 426. NATIONAL PROGRAMS-GRANTS AND CON- TRACTS. (a) The third sentence of section 4132(b) of the Act is amended by inserting "directly, or through grants, cooperative agreements, or contracts" immediately after "shall". (b) Section 4134(a) of the Act is amended by striking out "enter into" and inserting in lieu thereof "make grants to or enter into cooperative agreements or". (c) Section 4135 of the Act is amended by inserting a comma and "through grants, co- operative agreements, or contracts," imme- diately after "Secretary". SEC. 427. EVALUATION. Section 4132(d) of the Act is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new sentence: "In addition, the Secretary may conduct periodic evaluations of programs authorized by this Act.". SEC. 428. GOVERNOR'S PROGRAM-ADMINISTRA- TIVE COSTS. Section 4122 of the Act is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new subsection: "(c) Not more than 2.5 percent of the amount reserved under section 4121(a) shall be available to 'pay for the administrative costs of the chief executive officer in meet- ing his or her responsibilities under this part.". SEC. 429. GOVERNOR'S PROGRAM-HIGH RISK YOUTH. Section 4122(b)(1) of the Act is amended- (1) in the first sentence therein by insert- ing "that are designed" immediately before "for high risk youth."; and (2) by adding immediately after the first sentence therein the following new sen- tence: "A small number of individuals who are not high risk youth may participate in such programs if their participation does not significantly diminish the amount or quality of services provided to high risk youth.". SEC. 430. LOCAL PROGRAMS-DRUG TREATMENT. Section 4125(a)(5) of the Act is amended to read as follows: "(5) referral programs for drug abuse treatment and rehabilitation;". SEC. 431. EFFECTIVE DATE. (a) The provisions of this subtitle shall take effect 30 days from the date of enact- ment of this Act. (b) Notwithstanding subsection (a), a State educational agency may allot fiscal year 1989 funds to local and intermediate educational agencies and consortia under section 4124(a) of the Act on the basis of their relative numbers of children in the school-aged population. TITLE V-NATIONAL DRUG ENFORCEMENT AGENCY REORGANIZATION AND COORDI- NATION Subtitle A-Establishment of Office of Enforce- ment and Border Affairs in Department of Treasury SEC. 501. SHORT TITLE. This title may be cited as the "National Border Coordination and Reorganization Act of 1988". SEC. 502. DEFINITIONS. As used in this title- (1) the term "Office" means the Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs of the De- partment of the Treasury established by, part A of this title; (2) the term "Commandant" means the Commandant of the Coast Guard; (3) the term "Secretary" means the Secre- tary of the Treasury; (4) the term "Under Secretary" means the Under Secretary of the Treasury for En- forcement and Border Affairs appointed under section 5102(a); and (5) the term "function" includes any duty, obligation, power, authority, responsibility, right, privilege, activity, or program. PART A-ESTABLISHMENT AND OFFICERS SEC. 503. ESTABLISHMENT OF OFFICE. There is established within the Depart- ment of the Treasury an office to be known as the Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs, which shall consist of- (1) the office in the Department of the Treasury known on the day before the date of the enactment of this Act as the Office of the Assistant Secretary of the Treasury for Enforcement; and (2) the Coast Guard, as transferred by sec- tion 508. SEC. 504. UNDER SECRETARY FOR ENFORCEMENT AND BORDER AFFAIRS. (a) The head of the Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs established by section 503 shall be the Under Secretary of the Treasury for Enforcement and Border Af- fairs, who shall- (1) be appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate; and (2) report directly to the Secretary of the, Treasury. (b) The Under Secretary shall be paid at the rate of basic pay payable for level III of the Executive Schedule. SEC. 505. OFFICE OF BORDER MANAGEMENT AF- FAIRS. (a) There shall be within the Office of En- forcement and Border Affairs an office to be known as the Office of Border Manage- ment Affairs. (b)(1) The head of the Office of Border Management Affairs shall be the Assistant Secretary of the Treasury for Border Man- agement Affairs, who shall- (A) be appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate; and (B) report directly and be responsible to the Under Secretary. (2) The Assistant Secretary of the Treas- ury for Border Management Affairs shall be responsible for overseeing all activities of agencies and personnel under the jurisdic- tion of the Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs, other than activities relating directly to narcotics interdiction. (3) The Assistant Secretary of the Treas- ury for Border Management Affairs shall be paid at the rate of basic pay payable for level IV of the Executive Schedule. SEC. 506. OFFICE OF NARCOTICS INTERDICTION. (a) There shall be within the Office of En- forcement and Border Affairs an office to be known as the Office of Narcotics Inter- diction. (b)(1) The head of the Office of Narcotics Interdiction shall be the Assistant Secretary of the Treasury for Narcotics Interdiction, who shall- (A) be appointed by the President, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate; and (B) report directly and be responsible to the Under Secretary. (2) The Assistant Secretary of the Treas- ury for Narcotics Interdiction shall be re- sponsible for overseeing all narcotics inter- diction activities of agencies and personnel under the jurisdiction of the Office of En- forcement and Border Affairs. (3) The Assistant Secretary of the Treas- ury for Narcotics Interdiction shall be paid at the rate of basic pay payable for level IV of the Executive Schedule. SEC. 507. CONFORMING AMENDMENTS. (a) Section 301(e) of title 31, United States Code, is amended by striking "7" the first place that number appears and inserting in lieu thereof "9". (b) Section 5314 of title 5, United States Code, is amended by inserting after "Under Secretary of the Treasury (or Counselor)." the following: "Under Secretary of the Treasury for En- forcement and Border Affairs.". (c) Section 5315 of title 5, United'States Code, is amended by striking "Assistant Sec- retaries of the Treasury (7)" and inserting in lieu thereof the-following: "Assistant Secretaries of the Treasury (9).". Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2876 CONGRESSIONAL R.ECORI) - SENATE PART H-TRANSFER OF COAST GUARD TO OFFICE OF ENFORCEMENT AND BORDER AFFAIRS SEC. 505. TRANSFER OF COAST GUARD. (a) With respect to operation of the Coast Guard other than as a service in the Navy, the Coast Guard is transferred from the De- partment of Transportation to the Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs of the De- partment of the Treasury. (b) Nothing in this title shall be consid- ered to affect- . (1) the operation of the Coast Guard as a service in the Navy; or (2) the respective duties, with respect to the Coast Guard, of the Secretary of De- fense and the Secretary of the Nayy. SEC. 509. TRANSFER AND ALLOCATION OF APPRO- PRIATIONS AND PERSONNEL. (a) The civilian personnel of the Depart- ment of Transportation employed in con- nection with the Coast Guard, and the assets, liabilities, contracts, property, records, and unexpended balance of appro- priations, authorizations, allocations, and other funds employed, held, used, arising from, available to, or to be made available to the Department of Transportation in con- nection with the Coast Guard and the func- tions and offices transferred by this part, subject to section 202 of the Budget and Ac- counting Procedures Act of 1950, shall be transferred to the Office for appropriate al- location by the Secretary. Unexpended funds transferred pursuant to this subsec- tion shall be used only for the purposes for which the funds were originally authorized and appropriated. (b)(1) The transfer under this part of full- time personnel (except special Government employees) and part-time personnel holding permanent positions shall not cause any such employee to be separated or reduced in grade or compensation for 1 year after the date of transfer to the Office. (2) Any person who, on the day preceding the effective date of this part, held a posi- tion compensated in accordance with the Executive Schedule prescribed in chapter 53 of title 5, United States Code, and who, without a break in service, is appointed in the Office to a position having duties com- parable to the duties performed immediate- ly preceding such appointment shall contin- ue to be compensated in such new position at not less than the rate provided for such previous position, for the duration. of the service of such person in such new position. (c)(l) The Director of the Office of Man- agement and Budget, at such time or times as the Director shall provide, shall make such determinations as may be necessary with regard to the functions, offices, or por- tions thereof transferred by this part, and to make such additional incidental disposi- tions of personnel, assets, liabilities, grants, contracts, property, records, and unexpend- ed balances of appropriations, authoriza- tions, allocations, and other funds held, used, arising from, available to, or to be made available in connection with such functions, offices, or portions thereof, as may be necessary to carry out this part. (2) After consultation with the Director of the Office of Personnel Management, the Director of the Office of Management and Budget may, at such time as the Director of the Office of Management and Budget pro- vides, make such determinations as may be necessary with regard to the transfer of po- sitions within the Senior Executive Service in connection with functions and offices transferred by this part. SEC. SIt SAVINGS PROVISIONS. (a) All orders, determinations, rules, regu- lations, permits, grants, contracts, certifi- cates, lirenses, and privileges- (1) which have been issued, made, grant- ed, or allowed to become effective by the President, the Commandant, any Federal entity or official thereof, or by a court of competent jurisdiction, in the performance of functions which are transferred under this part, and (2) which are in effect at the time this part takes effect, shall continue in effect according to their terms until modified, terminated, superseded, set aside, or revoked in accordance with the law by the President, the Commandant, the Secretary, or other authorized official, a court of competent jurisdiction, or by operation of law, (b)(1) This part shall not affect any pro- ceeding, including notices of proposed rule- making, or any application for any license, permit, certificate, or financial assistance pending on the effective date of this part before any Federal entity and applications, to the extent that they relate to functions transferred under this part, shall be contin- ued. Orders shall be issued in such proceed- ings, appeals shall be taken therefrom, and payments shall be made pursuant to such orders, as if this part had not been enacted, and orders issued in any such proceedings shall continue in effect until modified, ter- minated, superseded, or revoked by the Commandant, the Secretary, by a court of competent jurisdiction, or by operation of law. Nothing in this paragraph shall be deemed to prohibit the discontinuance or modification of any such proceeding under the same terms and conditions and to the same extent that such proceeding could have been discontinued or modified if this part had not been enacted. (2) The Secretary may promulgate regula- tions providing for the orderly transfer of proceedings continued under paragraph (1) to the Office. (c) No suit, action, or other proceeding commenced by or against any officer in the official capacity of such individual as an of- ficer of any department or agency, func- tions of which are transferred by this part, shall abate by reason of the enactment of. this part. No cause of action by or against any department or agency, functions of which are transferred by this part, or by or against any officer thereof in the official ca- pacity of such officer shall abate by reason of the enactment of this part. (d)(1) Except as provided in paragraph (2)- (A) this part shall not affect suits com- menced before the effective date of this part, and (B) in all such suits, proceedings shall be had, appeals taken, and judgments rendered in the same manner and effect as if this part had not been enacted. (2) If, before the date on which this part takes effect, any department or agency, or officer thereof in the official capacity of such officer, is a party to a suit, and under this part any function of such department, agency, or officer is transferred, then such suit shall be continued with the Secretary or other appropriate official of the Office substituted or added as a party. (e) Orders and actions of the Comman- dant and the Secretary in the exercise of functions transferred under this part shall be subject to judicial review to the same extent and in the same manner as if such orders and actions had been by the agency or office, or part thereof, exercising such functions immediately preceding their transfer. '(f) Any statutory requirements relating to notice, hearings, action upon the record, or administrative review that apply to any function transferred by this part shall apply March 23, 1988 to the exercise of such function by the Com- mandant or the Secretary. SEC. 511. REFERENCE. With respect to any function transferred by this part and exercised on or after the ef- fective date of this part, reference in any other Federal taw to the.Secretary of Trans- portation shall be deemed to refer.to the Secretary of the Treasury. SEC. 512. TRANSITION. - With the consent of the Secretary of Transportation, the Commandant and the Secretary may use the services of such offi- cers, employees, and other personnel of the agencies or offices from which functions or offices have been transferred and funds ap- propriated to such functions or offices for such period of time as may reasonably be needed to facilitate the orderly implementa- 'tion of this part. SEC. 513. BUDGET FUNCTIONAL CATEGORY FOR COAST GUARD. (a) PRESIDENT's BUDGET.-For fiscal years beginning with the fiscal year 1990, the President shall, in accordance with section 1104(c) of title 31, United States Code, in- clude the Coast Guard (including all ac- counts funding the operations and activities of the Coast Guard) within functional cate- gory 750 for purposes of the budget of the United States Government submitted by the President pursuant to section 1105 of title 31, United States Code. (b) BUDGET RESOLUTION.-Any concurrent resolution on the budget considered under title III of the Congressional Budget Act of 1974 for fiscal years beginning with fiscal year 1989 shall use functional category 750 established by the President -under subsec- tion (a) in specifying the appropriate level of new budget authority and budget outlays for the Coast Guard. SEC. 514. EFFECTIVE DATE. This part shall take effect 30 days from the date of enactment of this Act. Subtitle B-Department of Defense Drug Interdiction Reorganization SEC. 520. DRUG INTERDICTION SUPPORT. (a) Section 136 of title 10, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following new paragraph: "(e) Within the Office of the Assistant Secretary of Defense for International Se- curity Affairs there shall be a Deputy As- sistant Secretary of Defense for Interna- tional Drug Interdiction and Enforcement who shall be appointed from civilian life by the President, with the advice and consent of the Senate. Subject to the supervision and control of the Assistant Secretary of Defense for International Security Affairs, the Deputy Assistant Secretary shall have as his principal duty the overall supervision (including oversight of policy and resources) of Department of Defense drug interdiction and enforcement activities (as defined in section 381 of this'title).". (b) Chapter 18 of title 10. United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following new section: " 3 381, Drug interdiction and enforcement activi- ties: definition "Department of Defense drug interdiction and enforcement activities are those activi- ties conducted in cooperation with civilian law enforcement officials under the provi- sions of sections 371-379, inclusive, of title 10, United States Code." (c) The table of sections at the beginning of chapter 18, of title 10, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following: "381. Drug interdiction and enforcement ac- tivities; definition." Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 29, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2877 Subtitle C-Establishment of a Senate Select Committee on Narcotics Abuse and Control SEC. 530. SELECT COMMITTEE. (a)(1) There is established in the Senate of the United States a select committee to be known as the "Senate Select Committee on Narcotics Abuse and Control" (herein- after in this subtitle referred to as the "Senate select committee"). The Senate select committee shall be composed of 15 Members of the Senate. (2) Members of the Senate select commit- tee shall be appointed by the majority and minority leaders of the Senate. One member of the Senate select committee shall be des- ignated by the majority leader to serve as chairman of the Senate select committee. (3) At least one member of the Senate select committee shall be chosen from each of the following committees of the Senate: The Committee on Armed Services, the Committee on Government Affairs, the Committee on Foreign Relations, the Com- mittee on Commerce, Science, and Trans- portation, the Committee on the Judiciary, the Committee on Appropriations, the Com- mittee on Finance, and the Committee on Labor and Human Resources. (4) Any vacancy occurring in the member- ship of the Senate select committee shall be filled in the same manner as the original ap- pointment. (b) The chairman of the Senate select committee may establish such subcommit-. tees of the select committee as he considers appropriate. Any such subcommittee shall be composed of not less than four members of the select committee. SEC. 531. LEGISLATIVE JURISDICTION. The Senate select committee shall not have legislative jurisdiction. The select com- mittee shall have authority- (1) to conduct a continuing comprehensive study and review of the problems of narcot- ics abuse and control, including, but not lim- ited to, international trafficking, enforce- ment, prevention, narcotics-related viola- tions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, international treaties, organized crime, use of the military in drug interdiction, drug abuse in the Armed Forces of the United States, treatment and rehabilitation, civil- ian drug interdiction programs, and the ap- proach of the criminal justice system with respect to narcotics law violations and crimes related to drug abuse; and (2) to review any recommendations made by the President or by any department or agency of the executive branch of the Fed- eral Government, relating to programs or policies affecting narcotics abuse or control. SEC. 532. AUTHORITY OF SELECT COMMITTEE. (a) For purposes of this subtitle, the Senate select committee, or any subcommit- tee thereof authorized by the select commit- tee, may sit and act at such times and places as it considers appropriate whether the Senate is sitting, has recessed, or has ad- journed. (b) For purposes of this subtitle, the Senate select committee, or any subcommit- tee thereof authorized by the select commit- tee to hold hearings, may hold such hear- ings, and may require, by subpena or other- wise, the attendance and testimony of such witnesses and the production of such books, records, correspondence, memorandums, papers, documents, and other exhibits and materials, as it considers necessary. Subpe- nas may be issued under the signature of the chairman of the Senate select commit- tee or any member of the select committee designated by him, and may be served by any person designated by such chairman or member. (c) A majority of the members of the Senate select committee shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business, except that the select committee may desig- nate a lesser number as a quorum for the purpose of taking testimony. The chairman of the Senate select committee, or any member of the select committee designated by him, may administer oaths or affirma- tions to any witness. (d) The Senate select committee and any subcommittee thereof and Its staff may con- duct field investigations or inspections. Members and staff of the select committee may engage in such travel as may be neces- sary to conduct investigations relating to the purpose of this subtitle. SEC. 533. STAFF. The Senate select committee may employ and fix the compensation of such clerks, ex- perts, consultants, technicians, attorneys, investigators, and clerical and stenographic assistants as it considers necessary to carry out the purposes of this subtitle. The select committee may reimburse the members of Its staff for travel, subsistence, and other necessary expenses incurred by them in the performance of the duties vested in the select committee, other than expenses in connection with meetings of the select com- mittee or any subcommittee thereof held in the District of Columbia. SEC. 534. AUTHORIZATION OF APPROPRIATIONS. There are authorized to be appropriated $400,000 in fiscal year 1989, $500,000 in fiscal year 1990, and $600,000 in fiscal year 1991 for salaries and expenses of the Senate select committee established by this sub- title. SEC. 535. REPORT. (a) The Senate select committee shall report to the Senate with respect to the re- sults of any investigation conducted by the select committee, or any subcommittee thereof, under section 532(d). (b) The Senate select committee shall submit an annual report to the Senate which shall include a summary of the activi- ties of the select committee during the cal- endar year to which such report applies. (c)- Any report of the Senate select com- mittee under this section which is submitted during a period in which the Senate is not in session shall be filed with the Secretary of the Senate. TITLE VI-RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT FOR LAW ENFORCEMENT AGENCIES Subtitle A-Establishment of New Research and Development Programs to Assist Federal Law SEC. 601. ESTABLISHMENT OF A RESEARCH AND TECHNOLOGY GROUP UNDER THE NA- TIONAL DRUG POLICY BOARD. (a) The Attorney General of the United States shall establish a Research and Tech- nology Group under the National Drug Policy Board. Such group shall be responsi- ble for reviewing the research, development, technology, and evaluation (R, D, T, & E) programs of the Department of Defense and the research and development programs of other nondefense Federal agencies .to assess their applicability to the operations, pro- grams, and missions of the Federal law en- forcement agencies..Such group shall con- sist of members of the Department of the Treasury, Department of Transportation, Department of Justice, Department of De- fense, and other appropriate Departments and agencies, at the Assistant Secretary level. (b) The Attorney General shall appoint an Executive Director of the group established by subsection (a), with responsibility for the daily operations of the group and for such other purposes as may be determined by the Attorney General to assure the effective op- eration of the group. (c) The Attorney General shall establish a Research; Technology and Acquisition Advi- sory Board, reporting to the Research and Technology Group established in subsection (a) of this section, and shall be composed of representatives from academia, private in- dustry, and agencies of the United States. The Advisory Board shall make recommen. dations to the National Drug Policy Board through the Research and Technology Group, including, but not limited to recom- mendations of how existing and new re- search and development findings can be ap- plied to the missions of Federal law enforce- ment agencies; potential program options for such Federal law enforcement agencies; and funding alternatives developed from re- views of technology bases, ongoing pro- grams, operational needs and special studies assigned by the National Drug Policy Board. The Advisory Board shall also be directed by the Attorney General to serve as an ad- vocacy group for the efforts of the new Na- tional Technology Development Centers es- tablished in section 602 of this subtitle, in- cluding, but not limited to, support for en- hanced funding for the Centers. (d) The Attorney General shall designate a Chairman of the Research and Technolo- gy Group established in subsection (a) and conduct an election of a Chairman of the Research, Technology and Acquisition Advi- sory Board from among the members of such Advisory Board, within 30 days of for- mation of the Advisory Board. SEC. 602. ESTABLISHMENT OF NATIONAL TECHNOL- OGY DEVELOPMENT CENTERS. (a) The President of the United States shall designate and establish within existing facilities of the Department of Defense, the Department of Justice, the Department of Energy, National Security Agency, and the Central Intelligence Agency, no fewer than eight, new "National Technology Develop- ment Centers" to develop technologies for application to Federal law enforcement agency missions. Such National Centers shall provide research, development, tech- nology and evaluation (R, D, T, & E) sup- port to the parent agency or department and the law enforcement agencies of the Federal Government. (b) The following existing United States Government facilities shall be redesignated as "National Technology Development Cen- ters": (1) For night vision research and develop- ment-Department of Defense, Army Mate- riel Command, Night Vision Laboratory at Fort Belvoir, Virginia; (2) For ground sensor research and devel- opment-Department of Defense, Army Ma- teriel Command, Communications Electron- ic Command, Fort Monmouth, New Jersey; (3) For physical/electronic security re- search and development-Department of Defense, Air Force Systems Command, Elec- tronic Systems Division, Hanscom Field, Massachusetts; (4) For imaging/electronic surveillance re- search - and development-Central Intelli- gence Agency and National Security Agency, Washington, D.C.; (5) For chemical/biosensor research and development-Department of Defense, Army Materiel Command, Chemical Re- search Development and Engineering Center, Aberdeen, Maryland; - (6) For chemical/molecular detector re- search and development-Department of Energy, Sandia National Laboratories, Albu- querque, New Mexico; (7) For physical/electronic surveillance and tracking, research and development- Department of Justice, Federal Bureau of Investigation and Drug Enforcement Ad- ministration, Washington, D.C.; and Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 - S 2878 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -- SENATE March 23, 1,988 (8) For explosives ordnance detection re- search and development-Department of Defense, Naval Ordnance Station, Indian Head, Maryland. (c) The President shall direct the appro- priate department or agency head to revise the statutory charter of each of such redes- ignated National Centers and submit appro- priate recommendations for legislation, if necessary, to the Congress to implement the designation of such National Technology Development Centers by no later than the end of the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989. The President shall direct the Direc- tor of the Office of Management and Budget to prepare a supplemental budget request to be submitted to Congress no later than 90 days from the date of the enact- ment of this Act, to fund the appropriate initial salaries and expenses required for each of the eight new Centers established in subsection (b) of this section for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989. (d)(1) The president shall direct each of the Federal law enforcement agencies of the Government to assign at least two technolo- gy advisors within such agencies, to serve as liaison officers to the new National Tech- nology Development Centers. (2) Each Federal law enforcement agency shall assign sufficient fulltime positions to the National Technology Development Cen- ters that meet that particular agency's mis- sion requirements, including support staff to enhance that agency's contribution to the Centers. (e) Beginning in the fiscal year ending September 30, 1990, no less than .002 of the aggregate research, development, technolo- gy, and evaluation (R, D, T, & E) budget of the Department of Defense and the service branches of the Armed Forces of the United States shall be made available to support the research and development activities con- ducted at the new National Technology De- velopment Centers for the Federal law en- forcement agencies. (f) Beginning in the fiscal year ending September 30, 1991, a separate line item budget account shall be established and maintained for each of the eight designated National Technology Development Centers designated by this subtitle. (g) The Comptroller General of the United States shall monitor the establish- ment of the National Technology Develop- ment Centers as authorized and mandated in this section, and shall report periodically to the appropriate committees of Congress on the progress of the implementation of these newly designated Centers. Subtitle B-Cargo Container Drug Detection Research and Development SEC. 603. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL APPRO- PRIATIONS. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated to the United States Customs Service for fiscal year- 1989, $5,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the Presi- dent in his fiscal year 1989 budget as pre- sented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used only for accelerating the devel- opment and availability of X-ray detection, nitrate detection, or other technologies to be utilized for the detection of illegal nar- cotics in cargo containers entering the United States at seaports, airports, and land borders. (b) The Commissioner of Customs shall coordinate and share the findings of the re- search and development authorized in sub- section (a) with other Federal departments and agencies with possible mission require- ments for such technology, including, but not limited to the Federal Aviation Adminis- tration and U.S. Coast Guard in the Depart- ment of Transportation; the Drug Enforce- ment Administration in the Department of Justice; and the appropriate State, and local law enforcement agencies, including airport authorities, port authorities, and other in- terested parties. (c) The Commissioner of Customs shall report his findings in either classified, or unclassified form, to the appropriate Com- mittees of Congress in conjunction with the President's submission of his fiscal year 1990 Budget of the United States. TITLE VII-DRUG ENFORCEMENT TRAINING IMPROVEMENT Subtitle A-The Federal Law Enforcement Training Center Improvement Act. of 1988 SEC. 701. SHORT TITLE. AUTHORIZATION OF APPRO- PRIATIONS. (a) This subtitle may be cited as the "Fed- eral Law Enforcement 'Training Center Im- provement Act of 1988". (b) There is authorized to be appropriated for salaries and expenses of the Federal Law Enforcement Training Center for fiscal year 1989, $10,000,000: Provided, That such ap- propriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used by the Center to increase the level of drug enforcement training, including basic and advanced training, for Federal, State, and local law enforcement officers: Provided fur- ther, That, on a space available, cost reim- bursable basis, the Center shall, to the extent practical, increase the level of train- ing for drug enforcement officers from for- eign countries that are cooperating with the law enforcement agencies of the United States Government. (c) There are authorized to be appropri- ated for salaries and expenses of the Feder- al Law Enforcement Training Center, $45,000,000 for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 199.0, and $50,000,000 for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1991: Pro- vided, That in each fiscal year addressed. in this subsection, support for the State and local law enforcement training program and the training programs for drug enforcement officers from foreign countries shall be maintained at no less than the level of sup- port in the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989. - (d) The Secretary of the Treasury is di- rected to expand the advanced training pro- grams for Federal law enforcement agencies at the Marana, Arizona, satellite facility of the Federal Law Enforcement Training Center, within the total amount of appro- priations authorized for fiscal years 1989, 1990, and 1991. (e) The Secretary of the Treasury is di- rected to report in writing to the appropri- ate committees of the Congress by no later than 90 days from the date of enactment of this Act with his preliminary plans for the increased training activities at the Federal Law Enforcement Training Center facilities to be funded with the additional appropria- tions authorized in subsection (b) of this section, and the authorized level of appro- priations contained in subsection (c). Subtitle B-Department of Justice Training Facilities Improvement Act of 1988 SEC. 702. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL APPRO- PRIATIONS FOR IMPROVEMENT AND EXPANSION OF DEPARTMENT OF .IUS- TI.C'E LAW ENFORCEMENT TRAINING FACILITIES. (a) This subtitle may be cited as the "De- partment of Justice Training-Facilities Ihn- proyement Act of 1988". (b) There is authorized to be appropriated for the existing law enforcement training facilities of the Department of Justice for fiscal year 1989, $10,000,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the Presi- dent in his fiscal year 1989 budget as pre- sented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used only for improvement of those facilities that are normally utilized for drug enforcement training activities.. (c) There is authorized to be appropriated for the expansion of law enforcement train- ing facilities of the Department of Justice and for new training facilities of the De- partment of Justice for fiscal year 1989, $10,000,000: Provided, That such expanded or new training facilities shall be primarily for basic and advanced training of drug en- forcement personnel of the Department of Justice. (d) The Attorney General of the United States is directed to report in writing to the appropriate committees of Congress by no later than 90 days from the date of enact- ment of this Act with his preliminary plans for the training facility improvements au- thorized in subsections (b) and (c). Subtitle C-Federal Law Enforcement Language Training Improvement Act of 1988 SEC. 703. FOREIGN LANGUAGE TRAINING. (a) The Department of Defense is author- ized to provide, on a cost reimburseable basis, foreign language training at the De- fense Language Institute to -special agents of Federal civilian agencies involved in drug law enforcement. (b) The Department of State is authorized to provide, on a cost reimburseable basis, foreign language training at the Foreign Service Institute to special agents of Feder- al civilian agencies involved in drug law en- forcement. (c) The Drug Enforcement Agency is au- thorized to- (1) detail special agent personnel for for- eign language training to the Defense Lan- guage Institute or the Foreign Service Insti- tute; and (2) reimburse, from appropriated funds, the Departments of Defense and State for the cost of training provided. (d) The Customs Service is authorized to- (1) detail special agent personnel for for- eign language training to the Defense Lan- guage Institute or the Foreign Service Insti- tute, or both; and (2) reimburse, from appropriated funds, the Departments of Defense and State for the cost of training provided. (e) The Immigration and Naturalization Service is.authorized to- (1) detail investigative personnel for for- eign language training to the Defense Lan- guage Institute or the Foreign Service Insti- tute: and (2) reimburse, from appropriated funds, the Departments of Defense and State for the cost of training provided. (f) The following amounts are authorized to be appropriated to implement the provi- sions of this section: - Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March,23, 1988 'CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2879 (1) to the .Commissioner of Customs, only for obligation for special agent foreign lan- guage training, $5,000,000; (2) to the Administrator of the Drug En- forcement Administration, only for obliga- tion for special agent foreign language training, $5,000,000; and (3) to the Commissioner of the Immigra- tion and Naturalization Service, only for ob- ligation for special agent foreign language training, $1,000,000. (g) Moneys appropriated pursuant. to this section shall remain available until expend- ed. (h) Moneys appropriated pursuant to this section shall be in addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to the Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989. Subtitle D-Authorization of Appropriations for Special Training Centers SEC. 704. ESTABLISHMENT OF NATIONAL TRAINING CENTER IN EL RENO. OKLAHOMA. (a) There is authorized to be appropriated to the Bureau of Justice Assistance for the fiscal year 1989, $10,000,000, for the.estab- lishment of a national training center in El Reno, Oklahoma, to be utilized for the training of Federal, State, and local prison officials in drug rehabilitation programs tar- geted to criminals convicted of drug-related crimes or who have developed drug depend- encies: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any other appropria- tions made available to the Bureau of Jus- tice Assistance in fiscal year 1989 for its other programs. (b) There shall be established a National Advisory Panel on Prison Rehabilitation Programs to consist of five members, three of whom shall be designated by the Director of the Bureau of Justice Assistance, one of whom shall be designated by the Majority Leader of the United States Senate, and one of whom shall be designated by the Speaker of the United States House of Representa- tives. (c) The Director of the Bureau of Justice Assistance, in cooperation with the Advisory Panel established in subsection (b), shall co- ordinate the establishment of the national training center as authorized in subsection (a). (d) The Advisory Panel shall have over- sight responsibility for the daily operations of the national training center in consulta- tion with the Director of the Bureau of Jus- tice Assistance. (e) The training programs authorized to be conducted at the national training center shall be for the benefit of: correctional offi- cers; administrative staff; and correctional mental health professionals including sub- contracting agency personnel. The national training center Is authorized to conduct counseling programs as recommended by the Advisory Panel. (f) Of the appropriations 'authorized under subsection (a), $6,000,000 shall be made available for the development of the national training center at El Reno, Oklaho- ma; $2,000,000 shall be made available for the development of a community-based resi- dential. "drug-free" program (therapeutic community) at the El Reno Federal Correc- tional Institute to be affiliated with the na- tional training center; and $2,000,000 shall be made available for the development of curriculum at the national training center: Provided, That the salaries and expenses.or personnel at the national training center, including those of the Advisory Board, and other administrative expenses of the nation- al training center, shall be made available with the $5,000,000 authorized for the devel- opment of the national training center. TITLE VIII-DRUG TESTING IN THE PRIVATE SECTOR SEC. 801. DRUG TESTING PROGRAM REQUIRE MENTS. (a) -No employer engaged in commerce or in an enterprise engaged in commerce or in the production of goods for commerce may- (1) refuse to hire an applicant for employ- ment, (2) take any adverse action against an em- ployee, or (3) discharge an employee, on the basis of the results of a drug test administered to the applicant or employee unless the drug test was conducted by a laboratory which meets the requirements of subsection (b). (b) Under the requirements referred to in subsection (a), a laboratory which conducts drug testing shall, as determined under guidelines prescribed by the Secretary of Health and Human Services- (1) meet the mandatory guidelines estab- lished by the Secretary of Health and Human Services under section 503(a)(1)(A)(ii)(I) and section 503(a)(1)(A)(ii)(III) of the supplemental Ap- propriations Act, 1987, (2) require a confirmatory test when an initial screening test is positive and shall not report a test aspositive unless it has been confirmed, and (3) provide guidance to the employers on procedures for the collection of specimens to be tested and on procedures for the chain of custody of such specimens. (c) An employer who takes an action de- scribed in subsection (a) on the basis of the results of a drug test conducted by a labora- tory which does not meet the requirements of subsection (b) shall be subject to a civil penalty of $10,000. SEC. 802. EFFECTIVE DATE. Section 801 shall take effect- (1) on the effective date of guidelines es- tablished by the Secretary of Health and Human Services under section 801(b), or (2) 6 months after the date of the enact- ment of this Act, whichever occurs first. TITLE IX-CONGRESSIONAL POLICY RE- GARDING ADDITIONAL FUNDING FOR FISCAL YEAR 1989 FOR ANTIDRUG ABUSE PROGRAMS SEC. 901. STATEMENT OF POLICY. (a) The Congress finds that- (1) the programs, projects, -activities, and initiatives contained in this Act are of criti- cal importance in developing a comprehen- sive approach to addressing the multiple facets of the drug abuse problem that faces the United States of America; (2) the President's budget for fiscal year 1989 as presented to the Congress on Febru- ary 18, 1988, contains funding for some but not all of the programs, projects, activities, and initiatives contained in this Act, and does not provide sufficient funding to launch a full scale assault on the drug abuse problem that plagues the United States; (3) there is an urgent and critical need for appropriations, in addition to those request- ed in the President's budget for fiscal year 1989 as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, to carry out the programs, projects, activities, and initiatives contained and authorized in this Act, and to ensure continuation of the momentum generated by the bipartisan Antidrug Abuse Act of 1986 (Public Law 99-570); (4) the additional appropriations required in fiscal year 1989 to accommodate the pro- grams, projects, activities, and initiatives contained in this Act should be included in the Concurrent Resolution on the Budget for fiscal years 1989, 1990, and 1991 with sufficient levels of appropriations allocated to the Committees on Appropriations of the House and Senate through the section 302(a) allocation process under the Budget Act of 1974, as amended to accommodate the programs, activities, and initiatives con- ?tained in this Act; and (5) the terms and conditions of the Bipar- tisan Congressional Leadership Budget summit should, if necessary, be amended to accommodate the level of new budget au- thority and outlays to fully fund the pro- grams, activities, and initiatives contained in this Act. (b) Therefore, it is the intent of Congress that- (1) new budget authority and outlays re- quired to carry out the programs, activities, initiatives contained in this Act shall be ac- commodated in the concurrent resolution on the budget for fiscal year 1989 and cross- walked to the Committees on Appropria- tions of the House and Senate and other ap- propriate committees of the Congress through the section 302(a) allocation proc- ess under the Budget Act of 1974, as amend- ed; (2) to the maximum extent possible, amounts authorized to be appropriated to carry out the programs, activities, and ini- tiatives contained in this Act, shall be pro- vided in regular appropriations bills or con- tinuing appropriations bills for the fiscal year ending. September 30, 1989; (3) any new budget authority and outlays required to carry out the programs, projects, activities, and initiatives contained in this Act, which are not provided for in regular appropriations Act for fiscal year 1989 or any continuing resolution for fiscal year 1989, shall be provided in the first available supplemental appropriation Act or ,resolution for fiscal year 1989 within 90 days of the submission of the President's 'fiscal year 1990 budget of the United States in January or February of 1989: (4) any such amounts appropriated for fiscal year 1989, either In regular appropria- tions Acts, continuing resolutions, or supple- mental appropriations Acts, shall not be provided through transfers from, or reduc- tions in, any amount appropriated for other purposes in regular appropriations Acts, continuing resolutions, or supplemental ap- propriations Acts for any other program, project, activity or initiative for such fiscal year, unless and only unless such amounts can be identified as nonessential administra- tive, nonprogramatic funds that are deter- mined by the Congress to no longer be re- quired to carry out ongoing programs; or only if such amounts are identified to come from unobligated, uncommitted balances of appropriated funds that Congress has deter- mined are no longer required to carry out ongoing, approved programs, projects, ac- tivities, or initiatives; (5) any amounts authorized to be, appro- priated for fiscal years 1990 and 1991 shall. be provided in regular appropriations Acts,. continuing resolutions, or supplemental ap- propriations Acts for those fiscal years and .under the same terms and conditions as con- tained in this. subsection; and - (6) the President of the United States shall direct the Office of Management and Budget to include sufficient levels of appro- priations in the fiscal years 1990 and 1991 budget of the United States to fully annual- ize the entire cost of the programs, projects, activities, initiatives, and personnel levels authorized in this Act and provided for in regular, continuing, and supplemental ap- propriations Acts for fiscal year 1989. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2880 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE TITLE X-FUNDING; ACCOUNTS Subtitle A-Offsetting Revenues and Savings to Cover the Cost of the Act SEC. 1001. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL APPRO- PRIATIONS FOR INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE. PROCESSING TAX RETURNS. There is authorized to be appropriated for processing tax returns, Internal Revenue Service, for fiscal year 1989, $4,675,000: Pro- uided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any appropriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1888 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending September 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase the number of tax enforcement personnel in the processing tax return activity by 186 fulltime equivalent positions over and above the personnel levels onboard as of September 30, 1988: Provided further, That an amount equal to additional revenues resulting from the en- forcement activities of the additional tax enforcement personnel provided under this section, beyond those assumed in the Omni- bus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1987 and the Joint Resolution entitled "Joint Resolu- tion making further continuing appropria- tions for the fiscal year 1988, and for other purposes, approved December 22, 1987, shall be appropriated to the Antidrug Abuse Fund established by section 9511 of sub- chapter A of chapter 98 of the Internal Rev- enue Code of 1986 to be disbursed by the Secretary of the Treasury to the agencies responsible for carrying out the other pro- grams, projects, activities, and initiatives au- thorized in this Act, and amendments made by this Act. SEC. 1002. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL APPRO- PRIATIONS FOR INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE, EXAMINATIONS AND AP- PEALS. There is authorized to be appropriated for examinations and appeals, Internal Reve- nue Service, for fiscal year 1989, $158,882,000: Provided, That such appro- priation shall be in addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase the number of tax enforcement personnel in the examinations and appeals, Internal Revenue Service activity by 3,829 fulltime equivalent positions to increase the amount of tax revenue assessments and col- lections beyond that assumed in the Omni- bus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1987 and the Joint Resolution entitled "Joint Resolu- tion making further continuing appropria- tions for the fiscal year 1988, and for other purposes", approved December 22, 1987: Provided further, That an amount equal to additional revenues, beyond those assumed in such Act and resolution, resulting from the enforcement activities of the additional tax enforcement personnel provided under this section, shall be appropriated to the Antidrug Abuse Fund established by section 9511 of subchapter A of chapter 98 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 to be dis- bursed by the Secretary of the Treasury to the. agencies responsible for carrying out the other programs, projects, activities, and initiatives authorized in this Act, and amendments made thereby. SEC. 1003. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL APPRO- PRIATIONS FOR INTERNAL REVENUE SERVICE. INVESTIGATIONS, COLLEC- TIONS, AND TAXPAYER SERVICE. There is authorized to be appropriated for investigations, collections, and taxpayer service, Internal Revenue Service, for fiscal year 1989, $123,056,000: Provided, That such appropriation shall be in addition to any ap- propriations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Congress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase the number of tax enforcement personnel at the Internal Revenue Service by 2,827 fulltime equivalent positions, over and above the personnel levels onboard as of September 30, 1988; to increase the amount of tax revenue collections beyond those assumed in the Omnibus Budget Rec- onciliation Act of 1987 and the Joint Reso- lution entitled "Joint Resolution making further continuing appropriations for the fiscal year 1988, and for other purposes, ap- proved December 22, 1987, for fiscal years 1989 and 1990: Provided further, That an amount equal to the additional revenues re- sulting from the enforcement activities of the additional tax enforcement personnel provided under this section shall be appro- priated to the Antidrug Abuse Programs es- tablished by section 9511 of subchapter A of chapter 98 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 to be disbursed by the Secretary of the -Treasury to the agencies responsible for car- rying out the other programs, projects, ac- tivities, and initiatives authorized in this Act, and amendments made thereby. SEC. 1004. AUTHORIZATION OF ADDITIONAL APPRO- .PRIATIONS FOR BUREAU OF ALCO- HOL, TOBACCO. AND FIREARMS SALA- RIES AND EXPENSES. There is authorized to be appropriated for salaries and expenses of the Bureau of Alco- hol, Tobacco, and Firearms for fiscal year 1989, $4,000,000: Provided, That such appro- priation shall be in addition to any appro- priations requested by the President in his fiscal year 1989 budget as presented to Con- gress on February 18, 1988, or provided in regular appropriations Acts or continuing resolutions for the fiscal year ending Sep- tember 30, 1989: Provided further, That such additional appropriation shall be used to increase the number of special occupa- tional tax enforcement and collection per- sonnel by no fewer than 40 fulltime equiva- lent positions over such personnel levels on- board at the Bureau as of September 30, 1988: Provided further, That such personnel shall be made available to accelerate the special occupational tax enforcement and collection effort at the Bureau in fiscal year 1989: Provided further, That an amount equal to additional revenues over projected fiscal year 1988 levels resulting from the en- forcement activities of these additional spe- cial occupational tax enforcement activities of the Bureau provided under this section in fiscal year 1989 shall be appropriated to the Antidrug Abuse Fund established by section 9511 of subchapter A of chapter 98 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 to be dis- bursed by the Secretary of the Treasury to the agencies responsible for carrying out the other programs, projects, activities, and initiatives authorized in this Act, and amendments made thereby. SEC. 1005. FEDERAL DEBT COLLECTION. (a) As used in this section: (1) The term "executive agency" has the meaning given to the term "agency" in sec- tion 552(e) of title 5. (2) The term "obligation" means any note, bond, debenture, or other evidence of in- debtedness, but does not include Federal Reserve notes or stock evidencing an owner- March 23, 1988 (not in exchange for goods or services) under a contract that requires the repay- ment of such funds with or without interest. Such term shall also include an obligation guaranteed by an executive agency and pur- chased by the Federal Financing Bank. Such term shall not include any commodity price-support loan made by the Commodity Credit Corporation or any loan made or in- sured under the Consolidated Farm and Rural Development Act. (4) The term "subsidy" means, with re- spect to a direct loan, the difference be-_ tween- (A) the costs (including interest) which would have been incurred by a borrower to obtain the loan from private sources, minus (B) the costs (including interest) which were incurred by the borrower to obtain the loan from the Government. (5) The term "debt" means an amount of money or property that has been deter- mined by an appropriate official of an exec- utive agency to be owed, to the United States by any person, organization, or entity except another agency. (6) The term "loan guarantee" means con- tingent liability of an executive agency. A guaranteed loan is- (A) any agreement in which an executive agency pledges to pay part or all of the amount due to a lender or holder in the event of default by the borrower; or (B) a direct Federal loan that an executive agency sold under a guarantee or agreement to repurchase. Such term does not include a loan guaran- teed under the Consolidated Farm and Rural Development Act. (7) The term "credit extension" means that portion of the credit management cycle involving review and approval of requests for short-term or long-term credit. (8) The term "financial contract" means any agreement or contract made by an exec- utive agency, the primary purpose or results of which is to make private credit available, or available on more favorable terms than in the absence of the contract, to a non-Fed- eral entity by indirectly or directly assum- ing the risk involved. Such term includes fi- nancial contracts such as an agreement to pay all or part of the principal or interest on the debt obligation of a non-Federal entity (debt service payments), financial lease agreements for assets and project fi- nancing, and repayment arrangements. (9) The term "creditworthy" means a fa- vorable determination entitling an applicant to receive credit, which is based on- (A) the perceived ability and willingness of the borrower to repay the debt and the lending organization's' level of acceptable risk: and (B) the consideration of other Federal ob- ligations that could jeopardize, or be jeop- ardized by, the new debt under consider- ation. (10) The term "receivables" means amounts owed the Government upon com- pletion of the acts giving rise to claims, and includes amounts such as amounts due for taxes, loans, sales of goods and services, fines, penalties, forfeitures, interest, over- payments, fees, duties, rents, royalties, claims, damages, audit disallowances, and travel advances. (11) The term "account servicing" means that portion of the credit management cycle dealing with monitoring the status of ac- counts of indebtedness, maintaining records of current debts, billing for amounts due, ship interest on the issuing executive collecting amounts due, collecting past due agency. amounts, handling debtor correspondence, (3) The term "direct loan" means a dis- performing followup functions, and provid- bursement of funds by an executive agency ing accurate reporting of debt portfolios. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2881 (12) The term "debt collection" means that portion of the credit management cycle dealing with recovery of amounts due after routine followup fails, and includes the as- sessment of the debtor's ability to pay, the exploration of possible alternative arrange- ments to increase the debtor's ability to pay, and other efforts to secure payment. (13) The term "delinquency" means the status of any account which is 30 days past due. (14) The term "default" means the failure to meet any obligation or term of a credit, grant, or contract agreement that causes the lender to accelerate demand on the bor- rower because of the severity of the borrow- er's breach of the agreement, and for pur- poses of this chapter, default occurs- (A) in the case of a direct loan, when the account is past due over 180 days; and . (B) in the case of guaranteed loan, when the Government repurchases the loan. (15) The term "reschedule"-means to es- tablish new terms and conditions to facili- tate repayment of a debt. (16) The term "referral for litigation" means- (A) referral to the Attorney General for' appropriate legal proceedings; or (B) in any case in which an executive agency has statutory authority to bring legal actions without referral to the Attor- ney General, referral to the organization within the executive agency that is respon- sible for litigation. - (17) The term "credit report" means any written or documented oral communication of information provided by a commercial or consumer credit reporting agency dealing with the creditworthiness or financial reli- ability of an applicant or debtor. - (18) The term "Under Secretary" means the Under Secretary of the Treasury for Debt Collection and Credit Management ap- pointed under section 3603 of this section. (19) The term "agency head" means, with respect to an executive agency, the chief ex- ecutive of the agency. (20) The term "function" includes any duty, obligation, power, authority, responsi- bility, right, privilege, activity, or program. (b) There shall be in the Department of the Treasury an Under Secretary of the Treasury for Debt Collection and Credit Management, who shall be appointed by the President, by and with the consent of the Senate. (c) The Under Secretary shall- (1) be the principal advisor to the Presi- dent with respect to Federal credit manage- ment and debt collection policy; (2) provide leadership, central direction, guidance, and monitoring of the executive agencies in credit management and debt col- lection and related financial reporting; (3) prepare and transmit to the Congress and the Comptroller General, within one year after the date of enactment of this sec- tion and in consultation with agency heads, comprehensive debt collection and credit management plans which comply with sub- section (d) of this section; (4) review executive agency credit man- agement and debt collection plans and poli- cies in order to assure that- (A) such plans and policies are- (i) consistent with the overall objectives, structure, and information requirements of comprehensive debt collection and credit management plans prepared under para- graph (3) of this subsection; and (ii) applied uniformly across agencies to assure parity and consistency; and (B) in the case of any project for the de- velopment of new or improved financial management systems, such project does not duplicate efforts by other agencies; (5) ensure that the President and the Con- gress are kept fully and currently informed of the Federal Government's- (A) financial position and results of its op- erations; (B) financial management condition; and- (C) requirements for financial resources to correct deficiencies and improve the effec- tiveness of accounting systems, financial systems, and systems of internal controls; (6) identify and establish financial man- agement objectives and information require- ments in order to define the data require- ments of standards established by the Comptroller General for the use by all exec- utive agencies in the development and oper- ation of their financial management sys- tems; (7) require each executive agency to submit comprehensive records describing in detail debt status and collection efforts, by program, project, or activity; (8) provide an annual summary of the ac- tivities conducted under this section to the Committee on Governmental Affairs of the Senate, the Committee on Government Op- erations of the House of Representatives, and the Committees on Appropriations of the Senate and the House of Representa- tives, describing the progress made in im- proving debt collection and credit manage- ment, and recommending such changes in Federal law for the purpose of improving debt collection and credit management as the Under Secretary considers appropriate; and (9) promulgate such regulations as may be necessary to carry out this section. (d) The comprehensive debt collection and credit management plans required under paragraph (3) of subsection (c), shall, at a minimum- - (1) establish credit management and debt collection practices, procedures, and regula- tions that implement and comply with this section and regulations of the Under Secre- tary, and all other relevant laws, regula- tions, rulings, and guidance; (2) define and assign debt collection and credit management responsibilities for each executive agency; (3) establish employee performance ap- praisal standards and bonus award pro- grams that take into account employee con- tributions to improving the operation of credit management and debt collection pro- grams; (4) establish accounting practices and pro- cedures and automated management infor- mation systems to enable each executive agency to produce accurate financial reports on those programs that generate receiv- ables, including reports such as operating statements, statements of financial position; and cash flow statements; and (5) require annual evaluations of credit management and debt collection operations and systems in order to identify areas in which such operations and systems could be improved and to initiate actions to correct any problems identified through such eval- uations. (e) Within 60 days after receiving a plan under paragraph (3) of subsection (a), the Comptroller General shall prepare and transmit to the Congress a report which contains the analysis and comments of the Comptroller General with respect to the plan and the progress being made by execu- tive agencies to strengthen credit manage- ment and debt collection. (f)(1)(A) The Secretary of the Treasury shall establish Federal credit management policies and promulgate regulations imple- menting this section. Such policies and reg- ulations shall apply to- (i) direct loans, loan guarantees, loan in- surance, financial contracts designed to sup- port borrowing, and debts arising from con- tracts, grants, and other administrative ar- rangements; and (ii) all executive agencies and Government corporations unless specifically exempted from Federal control by other statutory au- -thority. (B) The Secretary of the Treasury shall include in regulations promulgated under this paragraph regulations with respect to- (i) all credit practices necessary to make Federal credit practices substantially con- form to the best established credit practices of the private sector; (ii) credit analysis of borrowers (including determinations with respect to creditworthi- ness, financial responsibility, financial state- ments, identification of collateral, and abili- ty to repay); (iii) prescreening procedures (including the use of credit reports and, records from the same or other executive agencies to identify applicants who are delinquent or in default on debt contracted under other Fed= eral programs, projects, or activities); (iv) program eligibility; (v) alternative sources of credit; (vi) use of taxpayer identification num- bers; (vii) establishment of regular repayment schedules; (viii) account servicing practices (includ- ing adequate recordkeeping and documenta- tion, account review and loss estimates, fol- lowup procedures on delinquent accounts, and automation of loan servicing activities); (ix) debt accounting and reporting sys- tems; (x) interest, penalties, and administrative costs; (xi) administrative offset; (xii) use of collection agencies; (xiii) referral for litigation; (xiv) calling guarantees; (xv) controlling and foreclosing on collat- eral; (xvi) Federal employee salary offset; (xvii) income tax refund offset; (xviii) rescheduling; (xix) writeoff and closeout procedures; (xx) portfolio sales; (xxi) management review;-and (xxii) improvement plans. (2) Regulations promulgated under para- graph (1) of this subsection shall not apply to debt arising under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, the Social Security Act, the tariff laws of the United States, or to debts owed by State or local governments. (g) The Secretary of the Treasury shall prescribe minimum requirements for con- tracts for all loans or loan guarantees gov- erned by this section. -(h) The total amount of delinquent debts owed to executive agencies (other than debts arising under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986) shall be reduced by an amount equal to the amount of delinquent debt owed to the United States recommend- ed and targeted for debt collection in the President's Budget for fiscal year 1989 plus $2,000,000,000 (hereinafter referred to in this section as "additional collections"). (I) The Secretary of the Treasury, after consulting with each agency head and re- ceiving the proposals of each agency head for debt collection targets, shall develop and specifically establish debt collection targets for each fiscal year for each executive agency debt collection program. Such tar- gets shall be established in conjunction. with the provisions of the comprehensive debt collection credit management plans estab- lished pursuant to section subsection (c)(3) of this section and shall be designed to im- plement subsection (h). Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2882 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -- SENATE March 23, 1988 (j) To the extent that any debt collection targets established by the Secretary of the Treasury under subsection (i) of this section for an executive agency for a fiscal year are exceeded by such agency (not including ad- ditional collections), 15 percent of the amount by which such agency exceeds the targets for such, fiscal year shall be made available to the executive agency as addi- tional program funding for the particular program or activities involved in the debt collection activity. The balance of the delin- quent debts, other than additional collec- tions, collected under this section shall be returned to the Treasury of the United States and shall be used to reduce the public debt. An amount equal to the amount of such delinquent debts collected as addi- tional collection is appropriated to the Anti- drug Abuse Fund established by section 9511 of subchapter A of chapter 98 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986. (k) To the extent that any debt collection targets established by the Secretary of the Treasury under subsection (b) of this sec- tion for an executive agency for a fiscal year are not met by such executive agency, the amounts that were appropriated for the programs or activities at the executive agency failing to meet such targets shall be reduced by an amount equal to 15 percent of the difference between the amount col- lected by the executive agency toward its debt collection target and the actual debt collection target established by the Secre- tary of the Treasury under subsection (I) of this section. (1) The Secretary of the Treasury shall promulgate regulations which prescribe standards for use by executive agencies in developing proposals for debt collection tar- gets. Such standards shall require executive agencies to consider, for each program or activity, such factors as- (1) the characteristics of the debts and debtors involved; (2) the historical experience of the agency, other government agencies, and the private sector in the collection of similar types of debt; (3) the rates of delinquency and default; (4) planned Improvements in the agency's debt collection programs; and (5) such other factors as the Secretary of the Treasury considers appropriate. (m) Officers and employees of executive agencies responsible for the management of debt collection programs shall be held ac- countable (as part of the performance standards to be established under subsec- tion (c)) for establishing and periodically re- viewing and revising procedures and targets that comply with the requirements of this section and the regulations of the Secretary of the Treasury. (n) Any reductions to executive agency ap- propriations under this section shall be re- ported in detail to the Congress by the Sec- retary of the Treasury and shall be included in detail in all budget justifications present- ed by the executive agency to. the Congress. (o) Section 3711(f) of title 31, United States Code, is amended by- (1) striking out "may" after "legislative agency" in paragraph (1) and inserting in lieu thereof "shall"; and (2) striking out "may" after "system" in subparagraph (A) of such paragraph and in- serting in lieu thereof "shall". (p) Section 3718(a) of title 31, United States Code, is amended by- (1) inserting "to augment agency collec- tion efforts" after "appropriate";" (2) striking out "may" after "head of the agency" and inserting in lieu thereof "shall"; (3) striking out "; and" at the end of para- graph (1); (4) striking out the period at the end of paragraph (2)(B) and inserting In lieu there- of "; and"; and (5) inserting after paragraph (2) the fol- lowing new paragraph: "(3) the person will submit to the agency status reports on the success of such person in collecting such debts at least once every six months.". (q) Section 5514(a) of title 5, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new paragraphs: "(5) This subsection does not apply to in- tragency deductions for routine administra- tive overpayments which are the result of clerical or administrative error or delays in the processing of pay documents, and which are rarely controversial or disputed. With respect to these routine adjustments of pay, the agency should afford the individual rea- sonable opportunity to dispute the deduc- tion. Such opportunity need not be provided prior to making the deduction. "(6) No claim may be collected under the authority of paragraph (1) of this subsec- tion at any time after 10 years after the claim first accrues.". (r) Section 6103(m)(2)(A) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 is amended- (1) by inserting before the period a comma and "or other statutory authorities granting agencies independent claims collection au- thority"; and (2) by striking out "the Secretary may" and inserting in lieu thereof "the Secretary shall". (s) Section 3719 of title 31, United States Code, is amended- (1) by striking out "the Director of the Office of Management and Budget" in sub- section (a) and inserting in lieu thereof "the Under Secretary of the Treasury for Debt Collection and Loan Management"; (2) by striking out "Director" each place it appears in subsections (a) and (b) and in- serting in lieu thereof "Under Secretary"; (3) by striking out "and the Secretary at least once each year" in subsection (a) and inserting in lieu thereof "in accordance with regulations issued by the Under Secretary under section 3603 of this title"; (4) by striking out "and" at the end of subsection (a)(1)(E); (5) by inserting "and" after the semicolon in subsection (a)(1)(F); (6) by inserting after subparagraph (a)(1)(F) the following new subparagraph: "(G) the agency's progress in implement- ing chapters 36 and 37 of this title, and the agency's monetary and programmatic goals for improving collections and reducing de- linquencies and writeoffs;"; and (7) by striking out "and shall report annu- ally to Congress on the management of debt collection activities by the head of each agency" in subsection (b) and inserting in lieu thereof "and shall prepare (for inclu- sion in the budget submissions required by section 1105 of this title) a detailed state- ment of the Under Secretary's evaluation of each agency's implementation of its debt collection and loan management responsibil- ities for each debt collection and credit pro- gram administered by the agency". (t) Section 1105(a) of title 31, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new subpara- graph: "(26) a separate statement for each agency and program contains the informa- tion specified in section 3719(b) of this title.". (u) Section 3701(b) of title 31, United States Code, is amended to read as follows: "(b) In subchapter II of this chapter, the terms 'debt' and 'claim' mean any amount owed to the Government, except that such term does not include any amounts owed by one agency to another agency, and except as otherwise provided by law.". SEC. 1006. TRUST FUN!). Subchapter A of chapter 98 of the Inter- nal Revenue Code of 1986 is amended by adding at the end thereof the following new section: "SEC. 9511. ANTIDRUG ABUSE TRUST FUNS). "(a) CREATION or TRUST FUND.- "(1) IN GENERAL.-There is hereby estab- lished in the Treasury of the United States a trust fund to be known as the "Antidrug Abuse Trust Fund". "(2) ACCOUNTS IN TRUST FUND. The Anti- drug Abuse Trust Fund shall consist of such amounts as may be appropriated, credited. or paid to it as provided in this section. "(b) APPROPRIATIONS.- "(1) TRANSFER OF CERTAIN TAXES TO AC- COUNT.-There is hereby appropriated to the Antidrug Abuse Trust Fund amounts equiv- alent to the following amounts received in the Treasury on or after October 1, 1988- "(A) the additional amounts of collections resulting from the enforcement activities of the additional personnel provided under sec- tions 1001, 1002, 1003, and 1004 of the Om- nibus Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988 which is over and above that assumed with respect to such collections in the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1987 and the Joint Resolution making further continuing ap- propriations for the fiscal year 1988, and for other purposes, approved December 22, 1987, and - "(B) the additional collections referred to in section 1005 of the Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988. "(2) EXPENDITURES FROM FUND.-Amounts in the Trust Fund shall be available, as pro- vided by appropriation Acts, to carry out the purposes of the Omnibus Antidrug Abuse Act of 1988.". SUMMARY ANALYSIS OF THE OMNIBUS ANTI- DRUG ACT OF 1988 TITLE I-DRUG ENFORCEMENT AND PERSONNEL ENHANCEMENT Subtitle A. Asset Forfeiture Fund Amend- ments Act of 1988: Makes certain changes to the Treasury and Justice Department Asset Seizure funds to allow those funds to be more easily pro- vided to state and local agencies which con- tributed to the seizure. Allows some of those funds from the Jus- tice account to be used for prison construc- tion. Removes caps from those funds and takes the use of those funds off-budget. Subtitle B. State and Local Narcotics Con- trol Assistance: Authorizes the Bureau of Justice Assist- ance (which expires this year) and requires that the BJA Administrator be appointed by the President with the advice and con- sent of the Senate. Requires each state to submit a "master" plan or strategy which encompasses demand reduction, education, and law enforcement programs and delineates 30 different pur- poses for which these funds can be used. Establishes an expedited grant system for metropolitan areas with a population over 500,000. Provides accountability by implementing reporting and feedback requirements (pro- viding funds to carry out the same), while identifying those programs whch are suc- cessful, with the intent of encouraging simi- lar programs. Sets up a three-year approach by which a program funded in the first year would re- ceive the same funding for the following two years, and authorizes $250 million the Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE first year, $500 million the second year, and $750 million in the third year. $5 million and 96 FTE to allow BJA to im- plement this grant program. Subtitle C. Chemical Diversion and Traf- ficking Act of 1988: Identical to H.R. 2585, a bill to suppress the diversion and trafficking of precursor chemical and other chemicals used in the il- licit manufacture of controlled substances. Subtitle D. Comprehensive Federal Law Enforcement officer Improvements Act of 1988: Makes certain provisions for law enforce- ment officers, including increased death benefits for all federal, state, and local offi- cers. Establishes a National Advisory Commis- sion on Law Enforcement to examine pay and benefits and report to the President within six months. Subtitle E. Deportation of Convicted For- eign Drug Inmates: Provides for the deportation of "violent criminal aliens" who have been convicted of an aggravated violent felony, while provid- ing safeguards. Subtitle F. Customs Enforcement Amend- ments Act of 1988: Provides for the inspection of vessels by Customs officers under certain conditions on the high seas. Clarifies current law regarding transfer of seized assets to contributing state and local law enforcement agencies and foreign gov- ernments. Authorizes the Secretary of State to revoke the passport of any individual con- victed of a felony narcotics violation. Subtitle G. Authorization of Additional Appropriations for Drug Enforcement Per- sonnel, Fiscal Year 1989: Coast Guard. $45 million and 800 FTE's above the President's request. Customs. $30 million and 600 FTE above President's budget Border Patrol. $20 million and 500 FTE's above President's request. INS. $19 million and 225 criminal and or- ganized crime investigator FTE's above President's request. - ATF. $8 million and 140 FTE's over Presi- dent's request, including 10 FTE's to estab- lish a Bureau of Alcohol, Tobacco, and Fire- arms Drug Educations officers program, and certain reimbursements for state and local personnel. DEA. $60 million and 224 FTE's above the President's request, including five FTE's for program similar to above. FBI. $38 million and 400 FTE's above the President's request, including five FTE's for program similar to above. Marshals Service. $73.8 million above the President's request to be used as follows: 1. $11.5 and 230 FTE's for asset seizure and forfeiture activities; 2. $30.7 and 20 FTE's for jail cell renova- tions including Cooperative Agreement Pro- gram projects; 3. $10 million and 188 FTE's for criminal justice support activities; 4. $6.2 million and 104 FTE's for protec- tion of the federal judiciary and federal courts due to increased drug-related trials; 5. $4.6 million and 60 FTE's for Witness Security Program; and 6. $10.8 and 139 FTE's for fugitive pro- grams. $10 million and 200 FTE for additional U.S. Attorneys. Authorizes $150 million for new federal prison construction. Subtitle H: Authorizes rewards for information on narcotics fugitives. Prohibits dangerous weapons in federal courthouses. Authorizes payments to state and local ju- risdictions for the housing and care of per- sons in Marshals Service custody. TITLE II. INTERNATIONAL NARCOTICS CONTROL AND ASSISTANCE TO FOREIGN COUNTRIES Subtitle A. International -Drug Eradica- tion Improvement Program: Establishes an International Special Oper- ations Drug Eradication Squadron within State for use in source countries. Authorized an additional $12 million for the procurement of aircraft, equipment, O&M, and salaries and expenses for the Squadron. Requires the Secretary of State to estab- lish strict criteria and guidelines for employ- ing the squadron. Subtitle B. International Narcotics Mat- ters Improvement and Special Assistance Programs: Establishes a three-year economic assist- ance grant program under AID for source countries which meet specific eradication goals (15 percent verifiable in the first year, 40 percent by the third year to be deter- mined by DEA). Authorizes $200 million for the program for each of the three years. Directs the Comptroller General to moni- tor the program, and provides for a panel of Administration and Congressional repre- sentatives to assess the program after three years. Subtitle C. Amendments to Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961, as Amended: Implements certain changes to the report- ing requirements of the Act concerning the cooperation of source and transshipment countries in narcotics control. Subtitle D. International Narcotics Mat- ters Authorization of Appropriations: Authorizes $138 million in the first year and $150 million for the second year for INM, including: $500,000 to be used for coca eradication re- search; - $900,000 to provide protective equipment for aircraft used in narcotic eradication and interdiction efforts in source or transship- ment countries upon notification of Con- gress; and $2 million to be used for training in for- eign countries relating to narcotics control. Allows funds withheld from non-cooperat- ing countries to be used for narcotics con- trol in cooperating countries. Provides certain assistance for Bolivia; limits and conditions amount of funds which can be made available to Mexico; pro- vides other foreign assistance programs in- volving education and reporting. Subtitle E. Latin American Anti-Drug Strike Force: Creates within State an Ambassador at Large and Coordinator for Western Hemi- sphere Anti-Drug Efforts. Directs the Joint Chiefs of Staff to devel- op a plan for a Latin American strike force to eradicate and interdict narcotics in the Western Hemisphere (outside the U.S. and its territories). Would involve Latin American personnel using U.S.-provided resources. TITLE III. DRUG INTERDICTION ASSET IMPROVEMENT. AND ENHANCEMENT Subtitle A. Coast Guard: Provides $186 million for marine and air interdiction assets and for O&M. Subtitle B. Customs: Provides $110 million for Air Interdiction assets and $15 million for salaries and ex- penses. Subtitle C. Department of Defense: Provides $75 million for four aerostats, $15 million for surveillance flights and re- lated purposes, and $10 million for assets in S 2883 establishing the Latin American Strike Force. Subtitle D. DEA: Provides $48 million for the establishment of an International Drug Interdiction heli- copter force similar to OPBAT; $4 million will go to EPIC for enhancing tactical intel- ligence. Subtitle E. INS/Border Patrol: $20 million for Border Patrol equipment. Subtitle F. Establishment of Interagency Southwest Border Drug Interdiction Mobile Corridor Task Force: Provides $15 million for 100 Border Patrol, 25 Customs, and 25 DEA agents as- signed to two mobile corridor operations forces, with line authority given to joint commanders. Subtitle G. U.S.-Bahamas Drug Interdic- tion Task Force: - Authorizes $13 million for joint efforts. Subtitle H. Special Drug Interdiction Sup- port: Authorizes grant programs for procure- ment of assets to Puerto Rico-$7 million, Jamaica-$7 million, Dominican Republic- $5 million, Hawaii-$7 million. . TITLE IV. DEMAND REDUCTION Subtitle A. Treatment and Rehabilitation: Authorizes $20 million for grants to em- phasize community based residential treat- ment services such as halfway houses and therapeutic communities, including the pur- chase of land and construction of facilities. Subtitle B. Alcohol and Drug Abuse Treat- ment and Rehabilitation i Act of 1988: Authorizes $558 million in first year, and $583 million in the second year, and $608 million in the third year for Alcohol, Drug Abuse and Mental Health Bloc Grant pro- gram. Authorizes $600 million in the first year, $625 million in the second year, $650 million in the third year for Substance Abuse Emer- gency Drug Treatment Programs. Subtitle C. Drug-Free Schools and Com- munities Act Amendments of 1988: Authorizes $300 million in the first year, $350 million in the second year, and $350 million in the third year with specific re- porting and accountability requirements. TITLE V. NATIONAL DRUG ENFORCEMENT AGENCY REORGANIZATION AND COORDINATION Subtitle A. National Border Coordination and Reorganization Act of 1988: Establishes Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs within the Department of the Treasury, and places Coast Guard and Customs within that office. Subtitle B. Department of Defense Drug Interdiction Reorganization: Establishes within ISA a Deputy Assistant Secretary for International Drug Interdic- tion and Enforcement with the overall duty of DOD drug interdiction and enforcement activities. TITLE VI. RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT FOR LAW ENFORCEMENT AGENCIES Subtitle A. Establishment of New Re- search and Development Programs to Assist Federal Law Enforcement Agencies: Directs the establishment of a Research and Technology Group under the National Drug Policy Board and creates an advisory board to report to the Group. Designates 8 existing facilities under the Departments of Defense, Justice, and Energy and other agencies as "National Technology Development Centers" to devel- op technologies for federal law enforcement applications. Subtitle B. Cargo Container Drug Detec- tion Research and Development: Authorizes $5 million for developing tech- nology. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2884 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -SENATE March 23, 1988 TITLE VII.. DRUG ENFORCEMENT TRAINING IMPROVEMENT Subtitle A. The Federal Law Enforcement Training Center Improvement Act of 1988: Expands and improves the Federal Law Enforcement Training Center, and provides an additional $10 million for fiscal 89, a total of $45 million in fiscal 90, and a total of $50 million in fiscal 91. Subtitle B. Department of Justice Train- ing Facilities Improvement Act of 1988: Provides an additional $10 million for ex- isting Justice facilities and $10 million for new facilities. Subtitle C. Provides a total of $11 million to establish a foreign language training program for spe- cial agents of federal civilian drug enforce- ment agencies within the Departments of Defense and State. Subtitle D. Special Training Centers: Provides $10 million for the establishment of a National Training Center in El Reno, Oklahoma,-to train Federal, State, and local _ prison officials in drug rehabilitation pro- grams targeted to criminals convicted of drug-related crimes. TITLE VIII. DRUG TESTING IN THE PRIVATE WORKPLACE Requires that laboratories performing drug testing for the private workplace meet certain minimum standards, and that no action be taken against an employee or ap- plicant based on a test from a laboratory not meeting those minimum standards. TITLE IX. CONGRESSIONAL POLICY REGARDING ADDITIONAL. FUNDING FOR FISCAL YEAR 1989 FOR ANTI-DRUG ABUSE PROGRAMS Provides for the continuity of funding for the programs authorized in the Act and es- tablishes framework for partial offset of cost. COST BREAKDOWN OF OMNIBUS ANTI-DRUG ABUSE ACT OF 1988 (Note: These Figures Represent the In- crease Over the President's Fiscal Year 1989 Budget Request, Unless Otherwise Noted.) These Are Estimates of Budget Authority TITLE I: DRUG ENFORCEMENT AND PERSONNEL ENHANCEMENT Subtitle A: Asset Forfeiture Fund Amend- ments Act of 1988. No new budget authority required to im- plement. Subtitle B: State and Local Narcotics Con- trol Assistance. Estimated Cost: $250,000,000 FY 1989 (Total funding); 500,000,000 FY 1990 (Total funding); 750,000,000 FY 1991 (Total fund- ing); and 5,000,000 FY 1989 (96 FTE/BJA). Subtitle C: Chemical Diversion and. Traf- ficking Act of 1988. No new budget authority required to im- plement. Subtitle D: Comprehensive Federal Law Enforcement Officer Improvements Act of 1988. Estimated Cost: $10,000,000 (covers in- creased death benefits and Commission). Subtitle E: Deportation of Convicted For- eign Drug Inmates. No new budget authority required to im- plement. Subtitle F: Customs Enforcement Amend- ments Act of 1988 No new budget authority required to im- plement. Subtitle G: Authorization of Additional Appropriations for Drug Enforcement Per- sonnel, FY 1989. Estimated Cost: Coast Guard: $45,000,000/ 800 FTE; Customs Service: $30,000,000/600 FTE; Border Patrol: $20,000.000/500 FTE; and INS: Criminal Investigators: $3,000,000/ 50 FTE. INS: OCDETF agents: $16,100,000/175 FTE; BATE: $8,000,000/140 FTE; DEA: $60,000,000/224 FTE; FBI: $38,000,000/400 FTE; Marshals Service: $73,800,000/741 FTE; and U.S. Attorneys: $10,000,000/200 FTE. Subtotal: $303,900,000/3,830 FTE. (Note: FTE=full-time equivalent posi- tions.) Estimated Cost: Federal Prison System construction: $200,000,000 FY 1989. Subtitle H: Miscellaneous Law Enforce- ment Provisions. Estimated Cost: $1,000,000 for President's Media Commission on Alcohol and Drug Abuse Prevention. TITLE H INTERNATIONAL NARCOTICS CONTROL AND ASSISTANCE TO FOREIGN COUNTRIES Subtitle A: Internationa' Drug Eradica- tion Improvement Program. Estimated Cost: $12,000,00.0 FY 1989. Subtitle B: International Narcotics Mat- ters Improvement and Special Assistance Programs. Estimated Cost: $200,000,000 FY 1989, 1990, & 1991 each. Subtitle C: Amendments to Foreign Assist- ance Act of 1961, As Amended. No new budget authority required to im- plement. Subtitle D: International Narcotics Mat- ters Authorization of Appropriations. Estimated Cost: $30,000,000 FY 1989, $150,000,000 total funding,. FY 1990. 1,000,000 A.I.D. drug education program. Subtitle E: Latin American Antidrug Strike Force. Estimated Cost: $10,000,000 start up costs, funded in Department of Defense portion of Title III, Drug Interdiction Asset Improve- ment and Enhancement. TITLE III: DRUG INTERDICTION ASSET IMPROVEMENT AND ENHANCEMENT Subtitle A: Coast Guard: $186,000,000 FY 1989. Subtitle B: Customs Service: $125,000,000 FY 1989. Subtitle C: Department of Defense: $90,000,000" ("Also, $10,000,000 for Latin American Strike Force established in Title II.). Subtitle D: Drug Enforcement Adminis- tration: $48,000,000. Subtitle E: Border Patrol: $20,000,000. Subtitle F: Interagency S.W. Border Drug Interdiction Mobile Corridor Task Force: $15,000,000/150 FTE, incl. 100-Border Patrol; 25-DEA: and 25 Customs. Subtitle G: U.S.-Bahamas Drug Interdic- tion Task Force: $13,000,000. Subtitle H: Special Drug Interdiction Sup- port: $26,000,000, including: $7,000,000- Puerto Rico; $7,000,000-Jamaica; $5,000,000- Dominican Republic; and $7,000,000-Hawaii. TITLE IV: DEMAND REDUCTION Subtitle A: Treatment and Rehabilitation, Estimated Cost: $20,000,000 FY 1989. Subtitle B: Alcohol and Drug Abuse Treatment and Rehabilitation. Estimated Cost: Basic Block Grant Pro- gram: ADAMHA: $50,000,000 over President, FY 1989 (Total of $558,860,000). Basic Block Grant Program: ADAMHA $583,000,000 total, FY 1990. Basic Block Grant Program: ADAMHA $608,000,OOQ total, FY 1991. Emergency drug treatment grants: $435,000,000 over President, FY 1989. Emergency drug treatment grants: $625,000,000 over President, FY 1990. Emergency drug treatment grants: $650,000.000 over President, FY 1991. Subtitle C: Amendments to Drug-Free Schools and Communities Act. Estimated Cost: $50,000,000 over Presi- dent, FY 1989; $350,000,000 total, FY 1990; and $350,000,000 total, FY 1991. - TITLE V: NATIONAL DRUG ENFORCEMENT AGENCY REORGANIZATION AND COORDINATION Subtitle A: Office of Enforcement and Border Affairs. No new budget authority required to im- plement. Subtitle B: Department of Defense Drug Interdiction Reorganization. Estimated Cost: $100,000 FY 1989. Subtitle C: Establishment of Senate Select Committee on Narcotics Abuse and Control. Estimated Cost: $400,000 FY 1989; $500,000 FY 1990; $600,000 FY 1991. TITLE VI: RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT FOR LAW ENFORCEMENT AGENCIES Subtitle A: Establishment of New Re- search and Development Programs to Assist Federal Law Enforcement Agencies. Estimated Cost: $-0- FY 1989; $70,000,000 FY 1990. 'Subtitle B: Cargo Container Drug Detec- tion Research and Development. Estimated Cost: $5,000,000 FY 1989. TITLE VII: DRQc ENFORCEMENT TRAINING IMPROVEMENT Subtitle A: Federal Law Enforcement Training Center. Estimated Cost: $10,000,000 over Presi- dent, FY 1989; $45,000,000 total, FY 1990; and $50,000,000 total, FY 1991. Subtitle B: Department of Justice Train- Ing Facilities Improvement Act of 1988. Estimated Cost: $10,000,000 over Presi- dent, FY 1989 for expansion of existing fa- cilities; and $10,000,000 over President, FY 1989 for new training facilities. Subtitle C: Federal Law Enforcement Lan- guage Training Improvement Act of 1988. Estimated Cost: $11,000,000 over Presi- dent, FY 1989. Subtitle D: Establishment of National Training Center in El Reno. Oklahoma. Estimated Cost: $10,000,000 over Presi- dent, FY 1989. TITLE VIII: DRUG TESTING IN THE PRIVATE SECTOR No new budget authority required to im- plement. TITLE IX: CONGRESSIONAL POLICY REGARDING ADDITIONAL FUNDING FOR FISCAL YEAR 1989 FOR ANTIDRUG ABUSE PROGRAMS No new budget authority required to im- plement. TITLE X: FUNDING; ACCOUNTS Subtitle A: Offsetting Revenues and Sav- ings to Cover the Cost of This Act. Authorization of Additional Appropria- tions: Internal Revenue Service. Processing Tax Returns: $4.675,000/186 FTE over President, FY 1989; Examinations and Appeals: $158,882,000/3,829 FTE over President, FY 1989. Investigation, Collection, and Taxpayer Service: $123,056,000/2,827 FTE over Presi- dent, FY 1989. Estimated revenues from increased collec- tions available to offset cost of this act: $1,120,000,000 FY 1989; $2,222,000.000 Fiscal Year 1990 over President's budget. Authorization of Additional Appropria- tions: Bureau of Alcohol, Tobacco, & Fire- arms. Salaries and Expenses, BATF: $4,000,000 over President, FY 1989. - Estimated revenues from increased en- forcement of special occupational tax en- forcement by agency: $130,000,000 FY 1989; $140,000,000 FY 1990. Accelerated Collection of Delinquent Gov- ernment Debt: Department of the Treasury. Language in the bill that would mandate the collection of $2,000,000,000 over and above President's budget estimates for debt collection for fiscal year 1989; $2,000,000,000 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23,198,8 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2885 additional debt collections over current esti- mates for fiscal year 1990. Incentive _program for agencies that exceed established debt collection targets; penalties for those agencies that fail to meet established debt collection targets. Notes: All proceeds from the enhanced tax collections and debt collection payments would be deposited into a newly-established Anti-Drug Abuse Fund in Treasury; to be disbursed by the Secretary of the Treasury to the agencies responsible for funding the progrrams, projects, activities, and initia- tives authorized in this bill. . Total cost of Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988: $2,157,400,000 FY 1989 (Does Not Include Additional Funding Required to Collect Additional Revenues/Debt Collec- tion ). - Amount of additional tax collections/debt collections deposited into special fund to cover cost of this act: $3,250,000,0110 fiscal year 1989; $4,362.000,000 fiscal 1990. Total cost of Omnibus drug bill, Including additional staff/$$ for increased tax and debt collections: $2,448,013,000_ Total additional revenues available in FY 1989 to cover cost of .omnibus drug bill: $3,250,000,000. Difference: $801,987,000. SUMMARY OF COSTS: DRUG BILL Title I: $769,900,000. Title II: 253,000,000. Title III: 523,000,000. Title IV: 555,000,000. Title V: 500,000. Title VI: 5,000,000. Title VII: 51,000,000. Title VIII: 00.0. Title IX: 000. Title X: 290,613,000. Total new budget authority: Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act, 1988 $2,448,013,000. -$3,250,000,000 additional revenues avail- able to cover cost of Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988. Net cost: -801,987,000. Other notes: Bill authorizes hiring of 4,076 full time positions for law enforce- ment; US. Attorneys; and support person- nel. These are positions over and above President's fiscal year 1989 budget request of February 18, 1988. Additional staffing of 6,842 at LR.S. and 40 at BATF to collect additional revenue. ? Mr. MOYNIHAN. Mr. 'President, President Reagan was quoted in Time magazine of March 14, 1988, as haying said on February 29, 1988, that "The tide of battle has turned, and we are beginning to win the crusade for a drug-free America." Indeed. 'Smug- gling of cocaine and heroin into the United States nearly doubled between 1981 and 1986, according to the Office of Technology Assessment. The Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988 is based on the proposition that the 1 ederal Government should assume as a normal function the arrest, prosecution, and punishment of narcotics dealers. It is elemental. To help the Federal Government meet this responsibility, our bill authorizes much-needed funding increases for the Coast Guard, Customs Service, Border Patrol, Drug Enforcement Agency, and the Federal Bureau of Investigation. In addition, the Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988. resurrects an impor- tant program which iI have fought 'to maintain since the onset of the Reagan administration. That is the State and Local Narcotics Control As- sistance Program-the heir to the Law Enforcement Assistance Administra- tion. In 1984 and 1985, when President Reagan tried to eliminate it, I intro- duced legislation to 'save it. We were successful in doing so by including it in the Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1986. However, the administration has cut its budget substantially since then and proposed to eliminate it entirely for fiscal year 1989. Another important provision affects the numbers of drug law violators pending trial that have come to this country illegally. On the first day of the Congress., I introduced S. 48, the Criminal Alien Departure Act, to es- tablish a pilot program whereby drug- law offenders would be given the option of a trial, at taxpayers expense, or be deported immediately. There is a similar provision in the bill we intro- duce today; a bill that will do much to help the Federal-Government meet its responsibilities in the war against drugs.* Mr. GRAHAM. Mr. President, last week I was in Florida visiting in a small community in the northern part of our State, Madison, FL. There I met with Sheriff.Peevy, a long-time highly regarded law-enforcement official in our State. He told me that in that small community 85 percent of the persons who were incarcerated in the county jail were there because of a drug-related offense. They either had committed a drug-related crime or were supporing a drug habit. Mr. President, this is not an issue that is exclusive to a handful of large communities in this Nation. This is not an issue which is exclusive to a few areas of geography that are especially exposed to drug trafficking from inter- national sources. This is an issue which has come into the mainstream and the Main Streets of America. The strong steps which this legislation takes would be a statement of our na- tional commitment .to winning the war against drugs. I am concerned, Mr. President, that this is a war in which we have :sexlt out :mixed .signals. The actions which 'wiere taken in 1987 in terms of sharp recommended reduc- tions in the 1986 drug legislation would have been analogous to the United States, in 1942, having decided to surrender and retreat from the commitment that we made ion Decem- ber 8, 1941, in dedlaring war against the Axis. We need to see that our na- tional security and victory In the war against drugs are common objectives. They are not separate issues. They are issues which must be seen ,as necessary victories for America if America is to realize itts,fut'r re. Mr. President, I ask unanimous acon- sent to submit for the RECORD an arti- cle from the Florida Times Union of March 13 of- this year and an article from Newsweek of March 28 of this year outlining ,the drug situation in the catty Hof Jacksonville, FL, as well as on a national :front. There being no objection, the arti- cles were ordered to be printed in the RECORD, as follows: CRACK FUELS FIRE OF ILLICIT ACTIVITY (By Peggie I. Evans) "You want to buy some?" asked G.G., one of hundreds who sell crack cocaine on the streets of Jacksonville. Displaying a big wad of money pulled from his pocket,, G.G., 19, said he makes $800 a week selling crack in Brentwood Park, a public housing project on the city's Northside. Six months ago before entering the illicit drug trade, he said, he worked in a fast-food restaurant. G.G., unlike many who deal in crack, said he does not use -drugs, . and uses his money to buy clothes and for savings. As the use of crack soars in Jacksonville, more and more.people like G.G. are taking to the streets to make big money in a hurry, police say. "These are people who found a way to make money fast," said Jerry Rinehart, head of federal Drug Enforcement Adminis- tration office of Northeast Florida. "Jack- sonville was wide-open for it." In a little more than a year's tine, .crack, an inexpensive,. highly addictive form of co- caine that is smoked, has been designated as the Jacksonville Sheriff's Office No. 1 crime problem because of the violence and other crime it breeds. "What was a.minimum problem is now an epidemic," said Wayne Ellis, a-special assist- ant state attorney in Jacksonville in charge of a division set up to prosecute major drug cases in Northeast Florida. Cocaine seizures here that used to measure in the ounces now measure in pounds, Ellis said. Police blame .crack, which accounts for 46 percent of all felony drug arrests in Jack- sonville, in part for the city's burgeoning .murder rate-the highest in Florida-and growing crime rate, the second highest in the state. "The people who buy drugs here have to get money to buy drugs. They steal, they rob," said Captain W.K. David, head of the Sheriff's Office's narcotics division. "People don't rob a 7-Eleven for $50 for the profit" but for money to buy drugs, he said. Crime is terrorizing Jacksonville's poor neighborhoods, where most of the city's crack is sold-usually openly an street cor- ners-and where gunfights often break ,out. In one ,neighbnlthocd, near Myrtle and 21st streets, seven people were shot to 'death within a-ew weeks tm' a in late 19137. Escalating crime and drug fights have turned some neighborhoods into %artual war zones, with residents fearful to leave their homes. "We hear shooting at night. We don't know where its coming from," said a gray- haired grandmother who has lived in 'her small, neat home in.8pringtieeld for 14 years. "I used to feel safe living here." the woman sad. Now, she said, "I'm scared to go out at night." Springfield, once a 'neighborhood of, mostly big, fine homes, is largely.a rundown Northside neighborhood where many homes have been boarded up and abandoned. It is an area :infested with drug dealers, with street pushers openly flagging down pass- ers-by in an -effort to make a sale. "You walk two -blocks and you get killed," screamed a man repeatedly to a visitor to the neighborhood. "People ,are afraid of getting robbed or mugged if they leave their homes. And if Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2886 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE they leave their homes, they're afraid their homes will get robbed," said Jacksonville Councilwoman Sandra Darling, who repre- sents Soringfield. Ms. Darling uses a gun, an alarm system and three Doberman pinschers to guard her home in the neigh- borhood, she said. Across town in Colony Manor Apartments, a public housing project on the city's South- side, a mother recalls getting caught in the crossfire of a shoot-out as she and her child pulled their car into the drive of the project, where she said drugs are openly sold around the clock. "I didn't know whether to pull up or go backward. I had my little boy. We could have been killed." "I don't fault the police," the mother, who like other neighborhood residents inter- viewed did not want her names used for fear of reprisals from drug dealers. "The sight of police cars and they run," but minutes later they are back selling drugs," she said. At University Hospital, nurses and doctors struggle to care for infants born with co- caine addiction passed on to them from their mothers who are addicts. In crack houses-where addicts gather to buy and smoke the drug-and on street cor- ners around the city, young women sell their bodies for as little as $10, police say, just enough to buy another crack high. "It's going to get worse before it gets better," Ellis said. "We're in for a tough time for the next year or two." The reason crack use has spread so quick-, ly in Jacksonville and many other parts of the nation is because it is cheap, quickly ad- dictive, and profitable for drug dealers to sell because of the nation's abundant and increasing supply of cocaine, which made up the biggest share of the nation's.1987 esti- mated $130 billion illegal drug trade, say federal drug enforcement officials. Jacksonville's proximity to South Florida, the nation's hub for cocaine trade, has made it easy for dealers to get cocaine. The drug is usually transported from South Florida to .Jacksonville up -I-95, where heavy traffic makes it virtually impossible for police to halt the flow of drugs there, law enforce- ment officials say. A "hit," or dose, of crack costs $10 on Jacksonville's streets, vs. the $70 to $90 a gram for powered cocaine, making crack af- fordable to many. Crack users become ad- dicted to the drug in as little as two weeks, according to drug therapists. The tragedy of crack addition is compara- ble only to heroin addiction, and is perhaps worse, drug therapists say. "We've had patients go downhill in three months, lost their job, everything," said Mi- chelle Fitzhugh, a head nurse at River Region Human Services Inc., a nonprofit Jacksonville drug treatment center. "Some have engaged in criminal activity to buy the drug. You don't see that happen so fast in drugs except crack cocaine." A $10 hit of crack produces a high that lasts 15 to 20 minutes, and addicts can spend in the hundreds of dollars a day to feed their habits. After their euphoric high, ad- dicts experience extreme depression, rest- lessness and become paranoid, with an over- powering craving for yet another high. - Crack is made by cooking impurities out of cocaine, producing a more potent drug. Tiny yellow chunks of crack are sold on Jacksonville's streets in small, clear plastic bags that are used for storing contact lenses. The people selling crack on Jacksonville's streets number in the hundreds, police say, and many are making hundreds of dollars a day In drug sales. Many of them are crack addicts themselves, and many are armed with guns. and knives. Most street dealers are from Jacksonville, but growing numbers are from South Flori- da. Because South Florida is saturated with cocaine and because of heavy drug enforce- ment there, some small dealers are leaving the part of the state for greener pastures elsewhere to sell their drugs for a higher price with less risk to themselves. "When we put all the pressure on a place like Miami and those people start going to jail, people there start looking for another place to go" and some are coming to Jack- sonville, Rinehart said. An alleged crack dealer known as Bo Didley, who controlled crack sales in a 30- block area of Miami, left the city six months ago after his organization was battered by heavy arrests and drug seizures, police said. And according to Miami police Sgt. David Riggs, Didley has relocated his operation to Jacksonville. South Florida's estimated 200 drug kings who preside over much of the nation's drug trafficking, however, are not leaving their longtime base, DEA officials say. Jacksonville police and federal drug agents estimate there are less than a half dozen loosely knit organizations that are controlling a large portion of crack sales in Jacksonville. The organizations vary in size from 10 or 15 people to as many as 50 people who are responsible for transporting cocaine to Jacksonville, making it into crack, and distributing it to their numerous street dealers. On the streets, teenagers get paid $150 a day to patrol territories on bicyles and give street dealers warning of approaching police units or suspicious cars that may contain undercover police. The dealers often run and toss away their drugs, making arrests difficult. In addition to the organized crack oper- ations, police say numerous small entrepre- neurs are cooking up their own crack to sell on the streets. Many of the city's shootings and mur- ders-42 murders so far this year and 151 in 1987-have been triggered by crack dealers fighting over street territory or disputes over drug deals, such as when a crack user finds he has been sold chips of soap instead of crack, police say. The Miami Boys, violent crack dealers thought to be part of a cartel from South Florida, make up less than 10 percent of the city's crack dealers, DEA and Jacksonville sheriff's official said. Those running the city's crack cocaine or- ganizations, which like the street pushers are made up mostly of Jacksonville people intertwined with growing numbers from South Florida, are making as much as thou- sands of dollars a day, according to Jackson- ville narcotics Lt. W.B. Hodges. "They live in the fast lane. They drive big cars-usually several-like BMWs and Mer- cedeses," Hodges said. "They like gold. Big gold chains and big gold diamond rings. Gold seems to be their status symbol." The city's major crack dealers live in middle-class neighborhoods but may deco- rate their homes elaborately on the inside with expensive goods, Hodges said -"They spend most of their money on themselves and their women," saving little, he said. Under the Jacksonville Sheriffs Office's Operation Crackdown, a special task force set up last November to attack the crack problem, more than 1,000 people have been arrested in the last three months. But almost all have been street pushers and crack users, with the city's major crack deal- ers left unscathed. Federal and Jacksonville law enforcement agencies are focusing increasing resources on busting up the city's crack cocaine orga- March 23, 1988 nizations. When and if the busts are success- ful, there will be increased violence on Jack- sonville's streets as new dealers move in and fight it out over territory, said DEA special agent Brian Rafferty. "There will be gang fights and killing on the streets," said Rafferty, who is stationed in Jacksonville. But breaking up the organizations will also disrupt the flow of crack to the streets, says DEA's Rinehart, "It'll take organiza- tions one and a half years to get where these people are today," Rinehart said. Crack dealers, who are mostly young and black, are a separate and distinct group from cocaine dealers, who are mostly white, individual entrepreneurs who sell their drugs through a network of contacts rather than on the streets, Rinehart said. Powdered cocaine is an abundant in Jack- sonville as crack, which is used by blacks and whites, but the violence and crime asso- ciated with crack has made that drug law enforcement's biggest worry, police say. As part of Operation Crackdown, sheriff's officers posing as pushers have taken to the streets selling crack. Crack users have of- fered as payment for the drug such items as a moped, chain saw, a leather jacket and jewelry, items which most likely were stolen, said David of the city's. narcotics divi- sion. The sting operations with police acting as street, pushers, which some defense lawyers have decried as entrapment, began in Feb- ruary and are expected to continue at the rate of several a month. Police say jailing crack users, even if only for a short time, may deter them from seeking the drug when they are freed for fear of another arrest. Possession of crack is a felony, but sen- tences are often short because of jail and prison overcrowding. Street dealers are usu- ally charged with possession 'rather than stiffer trafficking charges because they carry only small amounts of crack, stashing the rest under a nearby bush or letting someone a block away hold most of their drug. Prosecutor Ellis said he is planning to take crack offenders into the public schools in a few weeks to talk to students about the addiction that has placed the addl. its behind bars and wreaked havoc in their li% es. Marijuana remains the drug of choice for most students because it is so cheap, but law enforcement officials worry that once teen- agers get out of school they may graduate to using crack. "Education is the key to this whole thing, "Ellis said, "We can't seal the borders, and we can't put a police officer on every corner." Darrel Gonzales started smoking marijua- na when he was 13 and by 22 was addicted to crack. Now 26, he is in a drug treatment for the third time trying to kick his crack habit. "It ruined my job that I had. It lowered my morale, my values. It destroyed every sense of responsibility. Nothing was as im- portant as me getting high," said Gonzales, who once worked at a stock brokerage firm. Before entering River Region for treatment, he said, he stole from his family and friends to help support his up to $100 a day crack habit. "It had to be God helping me," Gonzales, who was never arrested, said about his deci- sion to enter treatment again. "Crack will reduce you to nothing." - THE DRUG GANGS Bleak by day and terrifying by night, south-central Los Angeles could be the set for some B-picture about the world after a Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE S 2887 nuclear apocalypse-a nightmare landscape that the crack problem just keeps getting hundreds of subgroups, or "sets." Sets are inhabited by marauding thugs and hard- worse." formed along neighborhood lines, and only nosed cops, a world in which innocence is The ghetto gangs' entry into drug traf- a few have more than 100 bangers; 20 to 30 hostage to violence and bystanders too ficking on a major scale may be creating the members is commonplace. Leadership -is often wind up as victims. When darkness nation's biggest crime problem in decades. usually collective, and internal organization comes to Watts, law-abiding citizens cower Drug profits are soaring-and so is the drug- is rudimentary. One gang expert with the behind locked doors. Shadowy groups of , related homicide rate in cities where the Los Angeles Police ,Department, Deputy young men pad quietly down the alleyways gangs-are most entrenched. It is arguable, in Chief Glenn Levant, says most sets are as while police cruisers roam the streets and fact, that the emergence of drug gangs from casually organized as a, pickup basketball helicpoters clatter overhead. The police coast to coast is very similar to what oc- game. Bloods wear red and Crips wear blue; presence is overwhelming; anyone on the curred during the early years of Prohibi- traditionally, each gang member wears or street is liable to be stopped and questioned. tiori, when La Cosa Nostra-the Mafia-con- carries a bandanna (his "rag") to show his "Hands on the car, homeboy! Where's your solidated its status as an underworld cartel colors. (Many gangs also use "signs," which JD? What's that in your pocket? Got any by building on the profits of illicit alcohol. are hand gestures like a letter of the deaf dope? Seen any gang bangers? Where you "Look. at the development of organized alphabet, for identification when the mem- been, where you going?Answer me, homes- crime in the United States," says Thomas bers are not wearing their colors.) But local Fm talkie" to YOU." Reppetto, president of the Citizen's Crime variations on the theme are endless, and Week by week and year by year, the omi- Commission of New York, a privately Crip gangs are almost as likely to fight each nous statistics mount up: in 1987, when funded group. "If we've learned anything, other as they are to`fight-the Bloods. gang homicides rose to 387 in Los Angeles it's that once we let these guys get too big, The days when rival gangs fought each 'County, the cops made more than 12,000 to we've [control]. nora The situation that [ghetto] will gangs take s now w have decades other only over turf and colors are fading o gang-related arrests and countless thou- fast. In Los Angeles, Chicago, New York and sands of curb-side rousts in south-central an opportunity provided by the crack explo- Sion and the breakup of [traditional] orga? dozens of other cities, gang conflicts have ,L.A. The name of this tough and dangerous nized-crime groups. These gangs are where become a form of urban-guerrilla warfare gang is suppression-a massive attempt by the [Italian] gangs were when they moved over drug trafficking. Informers, welshers ,the outnumbered Los Angeles police and into bootlegging. We can't let that happen and competitors are ruthlessly punished; sheriff's departments to keep the estimated again." many have been a ssassinated. Gang turf, 70,00 gang members in Los Angeles County 'Kill him': The analogy to Prohibition, as which is still demarcated with graffiti in Los off balance and the defensive. It isn't work- Reppetto notes, has one significant flaw: Angeles, now involves inure than bragging ing. Despite years of experience combating today's ghetto gangs, especially the Jamai- rights; it is sales territory.Some, gang graffi- street crime, few L.A. cops will deny that can posses, are far more violent than the ti care coded threats. One in south-central their'war against the groups has taken a de- Mafia. In part, the extraordinary level of vi- .L.A..reads as follows: "Big Hawk 1987 BSVG cisive turn for the worse. The gangs are offence is the result of the ready availability c 187." To translate, Big Hawk is a gang better armed and more violent than ever of military and paramilitary weapons. Guns member's street name. BSVG stands for before; they are also more adept at evading like Uzis, AK-47 assault rifles and AR-15 se- Blood Stone Villains Gang, -a Bloods set. the law. It's like Vietnam, says one prosecu- miautomatics are widely bought (some even The lower-case c, which is 'deliberately x'd tor: "The cops are winning all the battles, legally in gunshops) by gang members, who out, indicates that the writer kills Crips, and but we're still losing the war." finance their high-tech arsenals with profits the number 187 refers to :the section of the The reason is-drugs-particularly crack, or from the drug trade. Another factor, ex- California criminal code for murder. "rock," cocaine. The trade, built on the - perts agree, is the sociopathic recklessness "Rollers and O;G.'s": The variety of :drugs enormous influx -of cocaine from Latin of these youth: big-city ghettos and barrios sold by big-city gangs includes heroin, mari- .America, is now transforming some of the are full of teenagers whose poverty and dep- Juana, PCP, hallucinogens and designer country's toughest street gangs into ghetto- rivation have immunized them to both hope drugs like fentanyl, a synthetic heroin that based drug-trafficking organizations. Equal- and fear. The result is a casual acceptance is even more potent than the real thing and ly ominous, according to law-enforcement of-and sometimes enthusiasm for-torture just as additive. But crack cocaine is the .sources, is the fact that at least some L.A. and murder, "drive by" shootings and public rage-and the scourge-of the ghetto. Crack gangs have now -established direct connec- mayhem. "If they don't kill you, they'll kill is a drug peddler's dream: it is cheap, easily Lions to major Colombian smugglers, thus your mother," BATF's Watterson says of -concealed and provides -a short-duration ensuring a continaus supply of top-quality the Jamaican gangs. "The Cubans and Co- high that invariably leaves the user craving cocaine. - lombians don't want to deal with them be. more. It was probably inevitable that street Dangerous as it is, the situation on the cause they're so dangerous." But the point gangs, observing crack's arrival in their 'West Coast is just part of a much larger applies to New York's black and Dominican 'neighborhoods over the past several years, problem. Big-city gangs in New York, Chica- drug gangs as well. Investigators say these -would be drawn into trafficking themselves, go, Miami and Washington, DC, are break- gangs make a point of staging their assassi- South-central Los Angeles today, like Miami ing Into the crack business as well, and some nations in broad daylight whenever possible. and New York, is flooded with crack. It is are actively spreading drugs and violence to "You don't kill no mother----- from across sold on street corners by peewees and in other cities all across the country. In Chica- the street," one young hit man explained to rock houses operated by bangers. Some- go, where gang membership has now undercover agents. "You walk up to him, where behind the scenes, much of the reached an estimated 13,000 after a lull in you kill him in his head." ghetto cocaine trade is controlled by what the 1970s, the infamous El Rukns are under Gang culture the mock-feudal tradition Los Angeles calls "rollers" and "O.G.'s"-old active investigation for drug tafficking. In of inner-city kids banding together for com- gangsters, a term that usually refers to gang New York, where a rookie cop was assassi- fort, support and mutual protection-has a veterans, many of them still in their 20s, 'hated by a cocaine kingpin's hit men three long and, some would say, romantic history who have been to prison. weeks ago, police are struggling to contain in America. Think -of "West Side Story." It Rollers, short for "high rollers," are gang an. explosion of drug-related violence that is still true .thi t many gangs are little more members who have made it big in the drug has left more than 500 persons dead in than collections of neighborhood youths trade, whether or not they are artuaily at upper Manhattan .alone during the past five with a penchant for macho posturing, petty - the ' top of the distribution pyramid. Typi- years. A Miami-based gang called the Un- crime and street brawls over girls or turf. -cally, rollers are in their teens or 20s. 'They touchables is pushing crack northward to Recruitment begins early, in the grade- tend to wear gold jewelry and drive flashy Atlanta, Savannah and other cities of the school years: gang veterans call their young cars: Datsun sports coupes, five-liter Mus- Southeast, where the group is known and acolytes "peewees" or "wannabees" (want- tang, BMW's and Mercedes-Benzes are feared as the "Miami Boys." to-be's). Though old hands say the custom is among the most popular models. Roger There are black gangs, Hispanic gangs, dying out, initiation by a Los Angeles gang' Hamrick, a community-relations worker in Asian gangs and gangs drawn from specific is supposed to be a brutal ritual known as Miami, remembers a gang member who nationality groups. Police from Boston to being "courted in" or "jumped in." To be moved to Daytona Beach, Fla., to peddle Huston are alarmed by the emergence of Ja- jumped in is to receive a beating adminis- crack. "When he left [Miamil, he was on a maican gangs known as "posses." According tered by three or four gang members: the bicycle," Hamrick says. "When he came to federal sources, there are 30 to 40 posses candidate is expected to show his fighting back, he wore more gold than Mr. T. and he with a total of about 5,000 members now op- spirit. If he passes the test, the peewee then was sitting in a white Mercedes. Iles not crating in the United States. Clannish, cun- becomes a "banger" or "gang banger" and is even 24 years old and he has two Merce- ning and extraordinarily violent, the Jamai- entitled to share in the gang's fortunes or, deses and a Rolex watch." Says Bill Blanco, cans are dominating the drug trade in care- more commonly, misfortunes tGeorge Will's another gang specialist in Miami. "Who you fully chosen cities from Texas to Alaska. column, page 76). are is dictated by the gold chains, the Rolex, "The bigger crack becomes, the bigger Colors and signs: The two most notorious the car. And everybody's got a car phone." the posses get," says special agent James L.A. gangs-the Bloods and the Crips-are Cellular telephones are more than decora. Watterson of the U.S. Bureau of Alcohol, not really gangs at all. Instead, the names tion: of course, they are extremely useful in Tobacco and Firearms. "And what's scary is denote legendary confederations among the drug trade. Beepers, which are equally Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2888 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE March 23, 1988 useful to dealers, are now so common among ghetto teenagers that Los Angeles public schools have banned them. Some gang veterans say the cocaine trade in south-central L.A. is controlled by 15 to 20 O.G.'s-an assessment that is shared by knowledgeable. law-enforcement officials. Deputy Chief Levant, who commands a new formed LAPD unit that specializes in major drug traffickers among the street gangs, says 75 to 100 gangs are now actively in- volved in cocaine distribution. Some of these groups, he says, now have sales total- ling up to $1 million a week. "There is a link between the South Americans and the street gangs," Levant says. That link-the strategic nexus between the Colombian cocaine cartel and street- level distribution in the United States-is becoming increasingly visible to investiga- tors in southern California and elsewhere. There is little question that some black drug traffickers have now established direct rela- tionships with top-level Colombian smug- glers. According to Los Angeles County offi- cials, the Colombians are even willing to sell drugs to O.G.'s and rollers on the consign- ment basis, a strong indicator of the cartel's trust. One example of the increasingly close connection between the Colombians and the ghetto dealers, was uncovered during Oper- ation Pisces II, a two-year investigation run jointly by the U.S. Drug Enforcement Ad- ministration and State and local authorities in California and Florida. Pisces II was a money-laundering sting aimed at identifying both smugglers and dealers. In a videotaped conversation between two Colombian smug- glers and detectives who operate the fake money "laundry," the Colombians admir- ingly described a black trafficker in south Florida. "That s.o.b, he just ordered and or- dered; it was hard to keep him stocked," one smuggler exclaimed.. "Those blacks are really the best ones," the second smuggler agreed. East and West: There is equally little question that some of the more aggressive big-city gangs have begun to spread the drug trade into the heartland. Police from Denver to Vancouver report that Los Ange- les gangs are moving in to establish branch operations selling rock cocaine. In Atlanta, Savannah and Montgomery, Ala., authori- ties say the Miami Boys are following the same expansionary pattern. Chicago gangs have appeared in Milwaukee, Minneapolis and Racine, Wis., and the Jamaican posses seem to be organizing crack outlets almost everywhere. Kansas City authorities recent- ly managed to break a Jamaican posse that began importing crack from its East Coast base sometime in 1985; the posse was oper- ating 75 crack houses that grossed $400,000 a day. After that success, however, Kansas City was invaded from the West Coast as well. In February four members of an L.A.- based Bloods gang were indicted for selling cocaine, and investigators say they have identified 15 L.A. gang members in their city. "This is the first time we've seen an American gang move into town," says U.S. Attorney Robert Larsen. "They're great en- trepreneurs." The big-city boys have two things going for them. First, they are usually able to buy top-quality cocaine directly from major smugglers at wholesale prices-as little as $10,000 per kilo. The second is that they are better armed and far more violent than the gangs or drug rings they encounter in small- er cities. As a result, they can compete suc- cessfully on price and quality-and if those classic business advantages are insufficient to establish a beachhead, they intimidate the competition with mayhem and murder. In Atlanta, says police Lt. John Woodward, the invading Miami Boys demonstrated the attitude that "we're bad and we'll prove it to you ... [they'll] walk up to [their competi- tors] and just kill 'em. It's not, 'I'm going to out-macho you.' It's 'I'm going to kill you'." The result, Woodward says, was 13 homi- cides In 1987. Enriched by their drug profits, big-city gangs can now easily afford the overhead of far-flung operations. The gang may send a scout-often a younger member-to test the market in the target city. If the first expedi- tion pans out, a larger group will follow to rent a ghetto apartment as a stash house for volume sales. Woodward says the look- outs and runners are often local. Body- guards may be either locals or out-of- towners. But the higher-ups, who control the stash and count the money, are always members of the invading gang. The amount of cocaine involved, Woodward also says, need not be large-a kilo or so every few days. Bring in "one kilo and you've got 10,000 bags of crack, and that will supply quite a few little housing areas for a few days," he says. "You're talking about $25 a bag, or $250,000 per kilo. The kilo costs (the Miami Boys] $10,000 to $12,000 in Miami, so there is a great, great profit margin here." The posses: Although there is still some controversy over just how well organized the American drug gangs are, no one doubts that the Jamaican posses are as disciplined as they are violent. Many members are be- lieved to be illegal aliens, and the groups themselves are usually based in Jamaican- immigrant communities on the East Coast- New York, Miami, Washington, D.C., among others. But their nationwide spread over the past several years has been staggering. The posses are major factors in the crack trade in most East Coast cities. They are also active in Dallas and Houston, in cities across the Midwest and, remarkably enough, they have recently been spotted in Anchorage, Alaska. Like most American drug gangs, the Jamaicans are known to hire local helpers when they open a crack house in a new city. But the core group is always from the island, and no outsiders are allowed to pene- trate the upper echelons of the ring. U.S. lawmen say many of the posses have their roots in the slums around Kingston, Jamaica. Their names reflect that genealo- gy. The Riverton City posse is named after a Kingston neighborhood, and so are the Maverly and Waterhouse posses. (The Ja- maicans call themselves posses after the armed bands in American Westerns.) Some, like the Shower and Spangler gangs, claim vague affiliations with Jamaican political parties: the Spangler posse aligns itself with the People's National Party of former prime minister Michael Manley, while the Show- ers identify with the Jamaican Labor Party of current Prime Minister Edward Seaga. Jamaican politicians, however, disavow any connection to the groups. In reality, must posses were probably marijuana-smuggling rings in Jamaica. But the crack explosion of the 1980s offers un- limited profits to the posses just as it does to American gangs, and Jamaicans have been even quicker than the American gangs to exploit the opportunity. South Florida, with its Colombian drug connections, is the adopted home for an estimated 1,000 posse members. The Shower and Spangler posses are the two main groups, and some lawmen say all other gangs are offshoots of these two. The lesser posses have exotic names like Dog, Jungle and Okra Slime. One group, the Jungle Lites, is reputed to be expert in guerrilla-warfare tactics, and police suspect they may have received mili- tary training in Cuba. Reggae and death: But every posse has a fearful reputation for violence. Nationwide, according to U.S. experts, the Jamaican gangs have been linked to 800 murders, in- cluding more than 350 last year alone. Posse gunmen are known to prefer shooting their victims in public, and reggae clubs in major cities have a well-deserved reputation for frequent homicides. A dispute between posse members at a raggae club in Houston last October led to a fatal shooting in front of nearly 100 witnesses, and New York police report that homicides occur almost weekly at a popular Brooklyn nightspot known as the Love People disco. Torture and maimings are posse trademarks as well. "They don't mind shooting people. We've had numerous cases of Jamaicans who were shot in the knee or leg," says Dallas police investigator Charles Storey. "A lot of groups have a potential for violence, but [the Jamaicans] demonstrate it daily." Dallas police say Jamaicans were linked to 35 homicides in 1987 and 10 to 12 so far this year. The explosive growth of the drug gangs nationwide is putting enormous pressure on police all across the country. Cocaine and heroin traffickers are now deeply en- trenched in the ghettos of many larger cities, and drug profits are a powerful incen- tive to. hundreds of thousands of unem- ployed black and Hispanic teenagers. In ad- dition, many gang members are increasingly expert in exploiting loopholes in the law. As a result, California and New York authori- ties are considering new anti-gang legisla- tion patterned after the federal RICO (Racketeer-Influenced Corrupt Organiza- tion) law; such state RICO statutes will enable prosecutors to seek longer prison terms for gang leaders convicted on other charges. Officials in cities like New York, San Francisco and Washington, D.C.-to say nothing of Los Angeles-are also being forced to reorganize their police depart- ments to meet the threat of drugs, which means cutting back on manpower for other crimes. "We need more resources-people and equipment," says Frank Storey, the FBI's chief drug official. "Resources are the most critical problem at the federal, state and local level." Outmanned, outgunned and outspent, the cops are fighting back as best they can. There is nothing they can do to control the spread of weapons like Uzis and AK-47s. As long as such guns have been adapted to fire only on semiautomatic-a procedure that is readily reversed by outlaw gunsmiths-the sales are wholly legal under federal law. Of- ficers who must deal with the gangs routine- ly wear armored vests (which often will not stop an assault-rifle round), and many de- partments now equip all their officers'with automatic pistols to increase their firepow- er. But ghetto busts are extremely danger- ous anyway: in Boston, for example, Police Lt. Det. Mel Ahearn has trained a special "Jamaican entry squad" to take on the posses in their strongholds. There is every indication, meanwhile, that the gang/drug problem will get worse. If the analogy to Prohibition is accurate, the gangs have only begun to consolidate their hold on drug trafficking-and given their growth so far, it seems reasonable to expect that they, like the Mafia before them, will become even more skillful in evading law en- forcement. The supply of smuggled drugs- Asian heroin, Mexican heroin and cocaine most of all-seems almost limitless. At the same time, the federal government, which has scattered the responsibility for combat- ing drugs among dozens of different agen- cies, seems to. lack a coordinated national strategy. Who's running the war, America's hard-pressed cops are asking-and when are the good guys finally going to win? Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 29, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE A JAMAICAN INVASION IN WEST VIRGINIA With its tidy clapboard houses and neat apple and peach orchards on land George Washington surveyed centuries ago, Mar- tinsburg, W.Va. (population: 13,000), seems far from the mean streets normally pa- trolled by drug gangs. But over the last three years, an invasion of Jamaican drug dealers' has turned the home of the Moun-_ tain State Apple Harvest Festival into a mecca for cocaine. The Jamaicans first arrived in Martins- burg as migrant workers to pick apples and peaches at harvest time, but many stayed on to peddle coke and crack. Hundreds squeezed into small apartments in a poor neighborhood called "the Hill" and trans- formed several blocks near the center of town into an open-air drug supermarket. Supplied by couriers shuttling between Ja- maican gangs in Washington, Miami and New York, as many as 50 dealers could be found brazenly hawking dope in broad day- light, just three blocks from the police sta- tion. At times business was so brisk that intersections were clogged with traffic; many cars bore out-of-state license plates. The customers "were all ethnic groups, age groups and every profession," says police chief Jack Strobridge. "They came riding up on skateboards, on bikes, in Mercedes-Benz cars, in pickup trucks." Stores in the region mysteriously sold out of vitamin B; police soon figured out that dealers were using it to "cut" the cocaine. Then the Jamaicans introduced crack-and started a run on plas- tic food-storage bags used to package the drug. Martinsburg's 28-man police force carried out small raids but were overwhelmed by the dealers. In a region where one or two murders per year was the norm, 20 homi- cides, all drug related, occurred in 18 months as rival dealers fought for control. Cases of venereal disease shot up as prosti- tutes imported by the dealers worked the streets. At local schools, students hired as drug couriers strutted around in expensive Nike jogging suits and gold chains, intimi- dating classmates and teachers. A police raid of a Jamaican dealer's house turned up crude photographs of a former homecoming queen posing half nude, pieces of crack lying about her. According to law-enforce- ment authorities, she later gave birth to a baby fathered by the dealer. Needles and knives: Residents were virtu- ally besieged in their homes. Theresa Sham- burg was unable to leave her driveway with- out being offered "crack, cocaine or reefer" by pushers. Discarded needles and knives littered her front yard. She called police but they were unable to drive away the dealers. One night, when the Jamaicans outside became particularly raucous, Shamburg woke to see her husband crouched with a shotgun in one hand and a pistol in the other, grimly waiting for a break-in. Under pressure from the community, local police asked the federal authorities for help. In fall 1986 some 200 agents from a special federal drug task force and local police raided 26 drug dens, arresting 35 dealers and seizing a cache of high-powered weapons. Police also found a "hit list" with the names of local judges and law-enforcement offi- cials. The suspects arrested insisted the names were targeted only for a mystical curse by Jamaican witch doctors. Even so, three county magistrates began carrying guns for self-protection. Street action: The raid pushed the most blatant dealers off the streets-at least for a while. Much of the street action moved down the road to Charles Town, 16 miles away. But many Jamaican dealers have kept up a flourishing underground trade in Mar- tinsburg. On warm days, Theresa Shamburg once again sees dealers congregating across the street. The Shamburgs will not wait to see what happens next. After three years of trying, they have finally found an out-of- town buyer for their home. They are moving . to a house in the country, but Shamburg suspects there is. no escape. She says 'T really don't think it's safe anywhere anymore." Mr. GRAHAM. Mr. President, final- ly I ask unanimous consent to join Senators D'AMATO, DECONCINI, and others of legislation providing for the death penalty for those who kill law enforcement officials during the com- mission of a drug-related crime. The PRESIDING OFFICER. With- out objection, it is so ordered. Mr. HATCH. Mr. President, I ask unanimous consent that I be listed as a cosponsor on the drug bill. The PRESIDING OFFICER. With- out objection, it is so ordered. ? Mr. DOMENICI. Mr. President, I am pleased to join Senator DECONcINI as an original cosponsor of the Omni- bus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988. We must acknowledge that the drug peddlers of this Nation and the world have declared war on the youth of America. The human cost of the plague of drugs is enormous in lost human potential. Drug abuse is a scourge and disgrace to our Nation. We must fight back. We have to fight the war against drugs on all fronts: On the border, on the high seas, in the air, in our schools, in our neighborhoods. The drug problem in American con- tinues. I cannot stress the gravity of this matter enough. Drugs are destroy- ing the minds and killing the people that use them. The number of mur- ders and crimes related to drug traf- ficking continues to escalate. I heard an alarming statistic from the Commissioner of the Customs Service at a hearing in my State this past summer. He did a simple calcula- tion just based on the number of indi- viduals who died consuming drugs versus the amount of cocaine con- sumed in this country. It shows that for every 150 pounds of cocaine con- sumed, one American dies. This does not even include the deaths involved in the trade-just the deaths based on the consumption of this one drug, co- caine. We are paying a high price in this country: The lives of our people. As we fight this war against drugs, the nefarious suppliers in other coun- tries are becoming increasingly cagey in subverting our efforts. We must beat them at their own game. In order to win this war, we must bring all the resources we have to bear on this problem. Two years ago, many of us in the Senate banded together to provide an effective arsenal of weapons to fight this war against the drug merchants. Our efforts have yielded results. We are doing a better job-seizures are up, but production is up, too. We are only keeping pace'with the drug producers and traffickers. S 2889 We have launched a war and a cru- sade, but we are just holding our own. More needs to do done. We need to attack drug abuse and drug trafficking on every front. The Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1986 started the momentum and now we need to continue it. .This is a war we cannot afford to lose, for this is a war over the minds and bodies of an-entire generation of ,our young people. The Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act contains new approaches to address both the supply. and demand sides of the narcotics problem. On the supply side of the problem, this bill provides grants for State and local narcotics control programs, con- struction of new jails, and funds for an international eradication program for drug-producing countries. On the demand side, the bill address- es the problem by providing funds for treatment. programs and facilities. I am really distressed to hear that people literally have to get on a wait- ing list to get into drug treatment pro- grams. One of the strengths of this bill is the help it will provide to State and local governments to address the treatment side of the problem. The price of our effort will. be high, but. the stakes are high. But we must ask ourselves, can we afford to do less? I think not. Therefore, I am support- ing this bill and hope we can enact into law soon, for every day we waste, more young people are lost to drugs.? Mr. HATFIELD. Mr. President, I am pleased to join many of my colleagues as an original cosponsor of the Omni- bus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988. The substantial number of Senators who have cosponsored this bill, Republi- cans and Democrats alike, demon- strates that the Senate recognizes that illicit drugs and drug abuse have become this decade's most severe do- mestic and international social prob- lem. During the past 8 years, the sheer magnitude of this crisis has become so great that no one can escape its conse- quences. Every aspect of our world is affected by illegal drugs, from the con- duct of foreign relations to the safety of the streets in Portland, OR. As the General Accounting Office recently reported, illegal drugs are costing the Nation tens of billions of dollars a year in lost wages, law en- forcement expenses and treatment. In- capable of calculation are the enor- mous costs to our citizens and commu- nities created by family strife, pain, suicide, violence, and suffering caused by narcotics and drug abuse. Mr. President, we are all too familiar with these alarming national statistics. Not as readily known, however, is the fact that drug trade and drug abuse are no longer "big city" problems. Cities such as Bend, Salem, Medford, and Portland, OR, have joined the ranks of New York, Washington, DC. Miami, Chicago, and Los Angeles as communities with serious drug prob- lems. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2890 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -- SENATE In my home State of Oregon, the Interstate-5 corridor, the major . West Coast interstate connecting Canada, Washington, Oregon, California, and Mexico, has become a major pipeline for the transportation of illicit drugs. Oregon is now thought to be the Na- tion's leading manufacturer of meth- amphetamine and the second largest producer of marijuana. My State's greatest asset-its attractiveness as a place to live and raise a family-is in danger of being tarnished unless we get the drug problem under control. Oregon has developed a dynamic part- nership between the Federal and State government in an effort to revitalize the local economy. That will be time and' money down the drain if we fail to eradicate this cancer of drug abuse and drug trafficking from our midst. This bill will assist States like Oregon that supply drugs to other parts of the country in shattering the myth that Latin America is the exclu- sive origin of our drug problems. Drug interdiction at the source means drug interdiction in Latin America, but it also means drug interdiction in Oregon and other prime drug manu- facturing targets in the United States. The effort being launched today by the introduction of this bill takes a comprehensive approach on an inter- national, national, and local level by addressing both the -supply and demand sides of the drug problem. The bill also provides incentives for in- creased cooperation between local, State, and Federal agencies in the war against drugs. Addressed in the bill are such things as drug enforcement and personnel enhancement, international narcotics control and assistance to for- eign countries, drug interdiction im- provement, demand reduction through treatment and rehabilitation, research and development, and enforcement training. A bill of this scope and size inevita- bly has provisions that are controver- sial. The total expense of this package in an age of budget deficits and provi- sions dealing with new prison con- struction, for example, are troubling to me. No one expects the Congress to adopt this bill in its entirety. As we proceed, however, we can make adjust- ments and amendments to the bill which will make it even better. Intro- duction of this legislation marks the beginning of a congressional effort to develop an effective national policy to combat this epidemic. I will be work- ing with the other sponsors of the bill and with members of the Appropria- tions Committee to accomplish this goal. ? Mr. SARBANES. Mr. President, I am pleased to join as an original co- sponsor of legislation being introduced today, the Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988. The legislation is a broad comprehensive measure that seeks to address the very serious problem of drug abuse and drug trafficking that threatens so many of our communities and our citizens. In fact, it is a prob- lem that is so pervasive that it threat- ens the very fabric of our society. This legislation is a much needed continuation of the Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1986, which I supported and which passed the Senate by an over- whelming margin in the 99th Con- gress. It continues the fight against drug abuse and the harmful effect that drug trafficking has on our coun- try. The bill attempts, in a comprehen- sive way, to address both the demand and supply side of the problem, and to significantly reduce both. It includes provisions to enable us to fight the drug menace at the local, State, and Federal level, and at our borders. I am pleased to see that a major em- phasis is on providing resources to our local and State law enforcement' agen- cies to combat the problem where it is really felt-in our neighborhoods and communities. In fact, just after the ad- ministration's budget for fiscal year 1989 was presented to Congress, the the Governor of Maryland and the Mayor of Baltimore alerted me to their deep concerns that no funds were included in the President's budget for antidrug law enforcement or for general law enforcement activi- ties at the local and State level. The State of Maryland estimates that one out of five inmates enters the Mary- land Division of Corrections on a drug- related conviction. In addition, an esti- mated 50 percent of the inmates in our State have some kind of drug or alco- hol related problem. The bill being in- troduced today provides a block grant to State and local governments for which they must outline how they will combat the drug problem using law enforcement, education, and demand reduction. There are also several major provi- sions in the legislation aimed at com- bating the flow of drugs into this country. First, the bill includes impor- tant initiatives to encourage drug source countries, especially in Latin America, to eradicate their illicit drug crops over a 3-year period. Second, there is a significant enhancement of Federal drug enforcement personnel and operations money for the Drug Enforcement Administration, Customs Service, Border Patrol, and the Coast Guard. These -agencies are absolutely vital in terms of drug interdiction. I think it is particularly significant that funds and personnel are being recom- mended for the Coast Guard when just a short time ago it was announced that drug interdiction efforts would be reduced by 55 percent and a number of important Coast Guard operations would be closed, including the Curtis Bay Coast Guard Yard in Baltimore. The Omnibus Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988 also includes much needed funds for drug and alcohol abuse treatment and rehabilitation, educa- tion for our schools and communities, and training for antidrug enforcement personnel. Mr. President, this is a com- prehensive bill that merits thorough and expeditious consideration by the March 23, 1988 Senate. It is a serious and significant effort to address the drug problems in our country.* By Mr. D'AMATO (for himself, Mr. DECONCINI, Mr. STEVENS, Mr. DOLE, Mr. GRASSLEY, Mr. TRIBLE, Mr. THURMOND, Mr. MCCowNELL, Mr. NICKLES, Mr. SYMMs, Mr. KARNES, Mr. HELMS, Mr. HATCH, Mr. GRAHAM, Mr. HECHT, and Mr. PRESSLER): S. 2206. A bill to amend the Con- trolled Substances Act to provide for the imposition of the death penalty for the intentional killing of a law en- forcement officer and for certain con- tinuing criminal enterprise drug of- fenses; to the Committee on the Judi- ciary. IMPOSITION OF DEATH PENALTY FOR KILLING OF LAW ENFORCEMENT OFFICERS AND CERTAIN CONTINUING CRIMINAL ENTERPRISE DRUG OF- FENSES Mr. D'AMATO. Mr.. President, I commend my colleague from Arizona, Senator DECONCINI, for his untiring efforts to bring to this point what I consider to be this Nation's most im- portant undertaking.. That is, to see to it that we pass legislation comprehen- sive in nature and to fund that legisla- tion to undertake a real war against drugs. To date, we have heard many proclaim that they want to take on this crusade. There simply has not -been enough action. There has been great rhetoric, particularly before po- litical campaigns, but little in the way of action. We have heard a great deal of concern about turf, about jurisdic- tion, about who will get to do what. However, we have heard little as it re- lates to what is taking place on our streets, in our neighborhoods and even less as to the resulting loss of domestic tranquility. Mr. President, one need simply look at Panama today to see this as an ex- ample of what the narcotics trade can and has done. Narco-militarism, which is spreading in Latin America, is a far greater threat, in my view, to our Na- tion's stability and the stability of this hemisphere than all of the Sandinis- tas. But I am concerned as it relates to that issue as well. This bill, Mr. President, provides for capital punishment in two cases. First, for the drug kingpin who intentionally murders or orders a murder as part of a continuing criminal drug enterprise. Second, for the intentional killing of a policeman or other Federal, State, or local law enforcement officer as part of a continuing criminal drug- enter- prise. We have just seen the most incredi- ble circumstance take place, one that no one ever would have believed. We have seen the intentional killing of a- 22-year-old law enforcement officer, New York Police Officer Edward Byrne, simply because the drug orga- nization wanted to demonstrate that they could and would kill a police offi- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE cer. This organization was outraged at being harassed because some of their members are being imprisoned for drug dealing. This murder is some- thing that no one could have ever con- jured or believed would have taken place. Mr. President, I again pay tribute to my colleague, Senator DECONCINI, for his leadership in this effort, for his tireless work and the work of his staff. There is a lot more that can and should be said. I intend to do that at a later date, but I think it is now time for action and for people of all parties and all political persuasion to come to- gether to meet the expectations of the American public by a first step in terms of enacting and funding this leg- islation. THE ANTI-DRUG ABUSE ACT OF 1988 The Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1988 provides more than $2 billion over the President's fiscal year 1988 budget re- quest to attack both the supply of, and demand for, drugs. This bill contains 200 pages of initia- tives to attack the many parts of this grave threat. These include: DEMAND REDUCTION: TREATMENT Bill provides $485 million over the President's budget next year for alco- hol and drug abuse treatment block grants. A $50 million increase for the alco- hol, drug abuse and mental health block grant, raising it from $508 mil- lion to $558 million; and A $435 million increase for the emer- gency drug treatment block grant, raising it from $165 million to $600 million. For the first time, our bill commits the Federal Government to help fund, drug treatment center construction and renovation on a large scale. It is estimated that $60 million is needed to build enough treatment centers to add 4,000 beds. Our bill permits up to $240 million for this purpose in fiscal year 1989. This would add 16,000 treatment beds nationwide. DEMAND REDUCTION: DRUG PREVENTION Our bill increases the President's drug education budget from $250 mil- lion to $300 million,* a $50 million in- crease in fiscal year 1989. It also tight- ens controls so that school districts will have to set goals for their pro- grams, evaluate-their success and fail- ure, and report on their efforts to cor- rect program weaknesses. SUPPLY REDUCTION.. DOMESTIC LAW ENFORCE- MENT: STATE AND LOCAL DRUG ENFORCEMENT ASSISTANCE Our bill rescues the State and local drug enforcement assistance program from extinction. It provides $250 mil- lion in fiscal year 1989; $500 million in fiscal year 1990; and $750 million in 1991. To ensure the quickest possible de- livery of drug enforcement assistance funds to cities with populations over 500,000, our bill requires the States to make funds available to those cities within 30 days of Justice Department approval of a State's application. FEDERAL LAW ENFORCEMENT BUDGETS ARE INCREASED BY $800 MILLION Coast Guard is transferred back to the Department of of the Treasury; $200 million for 4 new Federal prisons; expedited deportation of criminal aliens. SUPPLY REDUCTION: INTERNATIONAL EFFORTS- INTERNATIONAL ASSISTANCE This bill provides $600 million over 3 years for a new - economic incentive program to encourage drug source countries-like Bolivia, Peru, and Co- lombia-to eradicate 15 percent of their drug crops in the first year, and 40 percent over a 3-year period. There is now no such incentive pro- gram. Our bill does not offer a "give- away." To qualify for this assistance, a country has to earn it. It has to eradi- cate drug crops on a large scale. EXAMPLE OF BOLIVIA In 1987, Bolovia had 40,000 metric acres of coca under cultivation. To _ qualify for aid under our plan, Bolivia would have to eradicate 6,000 metric acres next year. State Department fig- ures indicate that our current strategy is clearly not working: coca cultivation in Bolivia is expected to increase by 4,000 metric acres next year. It is time for a change. I call on the House and Senate lead- ership to take up this drug bill at the earliest opportunity. This bill hits every important aspect of the anti- drug effort and carefully allocates re- sources between the supply and demand sides of the drug problems. It must be passed and enacted into law! Mr. President, I ask unanimous con- sent that the bill be printed in the RECORD. There being no objection, the bill was ordered to be printed in the RECORD, as follows: S. 2206 Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the United States of America in Congress assembled, TITLE I-DEATH PENALTY SECTION 101. ELEMENTS OF OFFENSE. Section 408 of the Controlled Substances Act (21 U.S.C. 848) is amended by inserting after subsection (b) the following: "(c)(1) If, in the course of engaging in a continuing criminal enterprise, a person in- tentionally, or with reckless indifference to human life, kills or participates substantial- ly in the killing of any individual, that person may be sentenced to death. "(2) If, in the course of engaging in orga- nized ongoing drug crime, a person inten- tionally kills a Federal, State, or local law enforcement officer engaged in, or on ac- count of, such law enforcement officer's of- ficial duties, that person may be sentenced to death. "(3) As used in this subsection- "(A) the term 'Federal, State, or local law enforcement officer' means an officer or employee of the United States, a State, a municipal corporation, a county, or other political subdivision of a State, who has au- thority under applicable law to enforce the criminal laws of the United States or a State; and S 2891 "(B) the term 'organized ongoing drug crime' means a felony violation of this title or title III which is a part of a continuing series of violations of this title or title III which are undertaken with 5 or more per- sons.". SEC. 102. PROCEDURE APPLICABLE WITH RESPECT TO THE DEATH PENALTY. Section 408 of the Controlled Substances Act (22 U.S.C. 848) is amended by adding at the end the following: DEATH PENALTY "(f) A person shall be subjected to the penalty of death for any offense under this section only if a hearing is held in accord- ance with this section. "NOTICE BY THE GOVERNMENT IN DEATH PENALTY CASES "(g)(1) Whenever the Government intends to seek the death penalty for an offense under this section for which one of the sen- tences provided is death, the attorney for the Government, a reasonable time before trial or acceptance by the court of a plea of guilty, shall sign and file with the court, and serve upon the defendant, a notice- "(A) that tha Government in the event of conviction will seek the sentence of death; and "(B) setting forth the aggravating factors which the Government will seek to prove as the basis for the death penalty. "(2) The court may permit the attorney for the Government to amend this notice for good cause shown. "HEARING BEFORE COURT OR JURY "(h)(1) When the attorney for the Gov- ernment has filed a notice as required under subsection (f) and the defendant is found guilty of or pleads guilty to an offense under subsection (c), the judge who presid- ed at the trial or before whom the guilty plea was entered, or any other judge if the judge who presided at the trial or before whom the guilty plea was entered is unavail- able, shall conduct a separate sentencing hearing to determine the punishment to be imposed. The hearing shall be conducted- "(A) before the jury which determined the defendant's guilt; "(B) before a jury impaneled for the pur- pose of the hearing if- "(i) the defendant was convicted upon a plea of guilty; "(ii) the defendant was convicted after a trial before the court sitting without a jury; "(iii) the jury which determined the de- fendant's guilt has been discharged for good cause; or "(iv) after initial imposition of a sentence under this section, redetermination of the sentence under this section is necessary; or "(C) before the court alone, upon the motion of the defendant and with the ap- proval of the Government. "(2) A jury impaneled pursuant to para- graph t 1)(B) shall consist of 12 members, unless, at any time before the conclusion of the hearing, the parties stipulate with the approval of the court that it shall consist of any number less than 12. "PROOF OF AGGRAVATING AND MITIGATING FACTORS "(i) Notwithstanding rule 32(c) of the Fed- eral Rules of Criminal Procedure, when a defendant is found guilty of or pleads guilty to an offense under subsection (c), no pre- sentence report shall be prepared. In the sentencing hearing, information may be pre- sented as to any matter relevant to the sen- tence and shall include matters relating to any of the aggravating or mitigating factors set forth in subsections (1) and (m), or any other mitigating factor. Where information Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2892. CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE is presented relating to any of the aggravat- ing factors set forth in subsection (in), infor- mation may be presented relating to any other aggravating factor. Information pre- sented may include the trial transcript and exhibits if the hearing is held before a jury or judge not present during the trial. Any other information relevant to such mitigat- ing or aggravating factors may be presented by either the Government of the defendant, regardless of its admissibility under the rules governing admission of evidence at criminal trials, except that information may be excluded if its probative value is substan- tially outweighed by the danger of unfair prejudice, confusion of the issues, or mis- leading the jury. The Government and the defendant shall be permitted to rebut any information received at the hearing and shall be given fair opportunity to present argument as to the adequacy of- the infor- mation to establish the existence of any of the aggravating or mitigating factors, and as to appropriateness in that case of imposing a sentence of death. The Government shall open the argument. The defendant shall be permitted to reply. The Government shall then be permitted to reply in rebuttal. The burden of establishing the existence of any aggravating factor is On the Government, and is not satisfied unless established beyond a reasonable doubt. The burden of establishing the existence of any mitigating factor is on the defendant, and is not satis- fied unless established by a preponderance of the information. "RETURN OF FINDINGS "(j) The jury, or if there is no jury, the court, shall consider all the information re- ceived during the hearing. It shall return special findings identifying any mitigating factors, and any aggravating factors set forth in subsection (1) or (m), found to exist. If one of the aggravating factors set forth in subsection (m)(1) and another of the aggra- vating factors set forth in paragraphs (2) through (7) of subsection (m) is found to exist, a special finding Identifying any other aggravating factor may be returned. A find- Ing of such a factor by a jury shall be made by unanimous vote. If an aggravating factor set forth in subsection (m)(1) is not found to exist or an aggravating factor set forth in subsection (m)(1) is found to exist but no other aggravating factor set forth in subsec- tion (m) is found to exist, the court shall impose a sentence, other than death, au- thorized by law. If an aggravating factor set forth in subsection (m)(1) and one or more of the other aggravating factors set forth in subsection (in) are found to exist, the jury, or if there is no jury, the court, shall then consider whether the aggravating factor or factors found to exist sufficiently outweigh any mitigating factor or factors found to exist, or in the absence of mitigating fac- tors, whether the aggravating factors are themselves sufficient to justify a sentence of death. Based upon this consideration, the jury by unanimous vote, or if there is no jury, the court, shall return a finding as to whether a sentence of death is justified. "IMPOSITION OF SENTENCE "(k) Upon a finding that a sentence of death is justified, the court shall sentence the defendant to death. Otherwise the court shall impose a sentence, other than death, authorized by law. "MITIGATING FACTORS "(1) In determining whether a sentence of death is to be imposed on a defendant, the following mitigating factors shall be consid- ered by are not exclusive: "(1) The defendant was less than 18 years of age at the time of the crime. "(2) The defendant's capacity to appreci- ate the wrongfulness of his conduct or to conform his conduct to the requirements of law was significantly impaired, but not so impaired as to constitute a defense to the charge. _ "(3) The defendant was under unusual and substantial duress, although not such duress as constitutes a defense to the charge. "(4) The defendant is punishable as a principal (as defined in section 2(a) of title 18 of the United States Code) in the of- fense, which was committed by another, but the defendant's participation was relatively minor, although not so minor as to consti- tute a defense to the charge. "(5) The defendant could not reasonably have foreseen that his conduct in the course of the commission of murder, or other of- fense resulting in death for which the de- fendant was convicted, would cause, or would create a grave risk of causing, death to any person. "AGGRAVATING FACTORS FOR HOMICIDE "(m) If the defendant is found guilty of or pleads guilty to an offense under subsection (c), the following aggravating factors shall be considered but are not exclusive: "(1) The defendant- "(A) intentionally killed the victim; "(B) intentionally inflicted serious bodily injury which resulted in the death of the victim; "(C) intentionally engaged in conduct in- tending that the victim be , killed or that lethal force be employed against the victim, which resulted in the-death of the victim. "(D) intentionally engaged in conduct which- "(I) the defendant knew would create a grave risk or death to a person, other than one of the participants in the offense; and "(ii) resulted in the death of the victim. "(2) The defendant has been convicted of another Federal offense, or a State offense resulting in the death of a person, for which a sentence of life imprisonment or a sen- tence of death was authorized by statute. "(3) The defendant has previously been convicted of two or more State or Federal offenses punishable by a term of imprison- ment of more than one year, committed on different occasions, involving the infliction of, or attempted infliction of, serious bodily injury upon another person. "(4) The defendant has previously been convicted of two or more State or Federal offenses punishable by a term of imprison- ment of more than one year, committed on different occasions, involving the distribu- tion of a controlled substance., "(5) In the commission of the offense or in escaping apprehension for a violation of subsection (c), the defendant knowingly cre- ated a grave risk of death to one or more persons in addition to the victims of the of- fense. "(6) The violation of this chapter In rela- tion to which the conduct described in sub- section (c) occurred was a violation of sec- tion 405. "(7) The defendant committed the offense in an especially heinous, cruel, or depraved manner. "INSTRUCTION TO JURY ON RIGHT OF THE DE- FENDANT TO JUSTICE WITHOUT DISCRIMINA- TION "(n) In any hearing held before a jury under this section, the court shall instruct the jury that in its consideration of whether the sentence of death is justified it shall not consider the race, color, national origin, creed, or sex of the defendant. The jury shall return to the court a certificate signed by each juror that consideration of race, color, national origin, creed, or sex of the March 29, 1988 defendant was not involved in reaching his or her Individual decision. "SENTENCING IN CAPITAL CASES IN WHICH DEATH- PENALTY IS NOT SOUGHT OR IMPOSED "(o) If a person is convicted for an offense under subsection (c) and the court does not impose the penalty of death, the court may impose a sentence of life imprisonment without the possibility of parole. "APPEAL IN CAPITAL CASES "(p)(1) In any case in which the sentence of death is imposed under this section, the sentence of death shall be subject to review by the court of appeals upon appeal by the defendant. Notice of appeal must be filed within the time prescribed for appeal of judgment in section 2107 of title 28 of the United States Code. An appeal under this section may be consolidated with an appeal of the judgment of conviction. Such review shall have priority over all other cases. "(2) On review of the sentence, the court of appeals shall consider the record, the evi- dence submitted during the trial, the infor- mation submitted during the sentencing hearing, the procedures employed in the sentencing hearing, and the special findings returned under this section. "(3) The court shall affirm the sentence if it determines that- "(A) the sentence of death was not im- posed under the influence of passion, preju- dice, or any other arbitrary factor; and "(B) the information supports the special finding of the existence of every aggravat- ing factor upon which the sentence was based, together with or the failure to find- ing any mitigating factors as set forth or al- lowed in this section. In all other cases the court shall remand the case for reconsideration under this sec- tion. The court of appeals shall state in writing the reasons for its disposition of the review of the sentence.". Mr. DECONCINI. Mr. President, I thank the Senator from New York for his leadership in this area. Mr. President, moments ago, I intro- duced along with my good friend and colleague Senator D'AMATO, the Anti- Drug Abuse Act of 1988. In order to further strengthen our law-enforce- ment efforts against those who deal in illegal drugs, I rise in support of the amendment Senator D'AMATo has in- troduced that will provide the kind of deterrent that I believe would truly send a message to drug traffickers and drug dealers-the United States takes this problem seriously, and we are ready to deal with it in a serious manner. The D'Amato amendment would amend the Controlled Substances Act to provide for the imposition of the death penalty for drug-related mur- ders and for the intentional killing of a law-enforcement officer as part of a criminal drug enterprise. Those who deal in illicit drugs have demonstrated a total disregard for human life. The Jamaican gangs, who call themselves "posses", taken from the old wild west movies, have taken control of the "crack" trade in cities across the country. They are better ' armed than the police-and it is not unusual for them to be armed with AK-47's or UZIS. Law enforcement ex- perts believe they have been responsi- Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE ble for at least 600 murders in the last 3 years. Let me provide an example from Ari- zona of the brutality and ruthlessness of those who deal in drugs. Witnesses recently testified in Tucson that a 17- year-old Tucson High School student was murdered because he owed his al- leged killer $2 million and 4 kilos of cocaine. The 18-year-old suspect in the case told detectives that he put a wire around the victim's neck and strangled him while two other subjects beat him. Two years ago when the Senate was working on the Anti-Drug Abuse Act of 1986, the Senate refused to vote di- rectly on the death penalty amend- ment for drug traffickers and instead used a procedural vote to sidestep the issue. I voted against tabling the death penalty amendment 2 years ago and I believe the argument in favor of this kind of deterrent is stronger than ever. The American people have consist- ently demonstrated in opinion polls that they strongly support the death penalty. More than 80 percent of my constituents in Arizona favor the death penalty. Some argue that the death penalty should not be imple- mented because of the possibility of mistake. I find this argument to be un- convincing in light of the extensive procedural safeguards for capital de- fendants. A chronology of the legal procedures required and available to these defend- ants would convince any reasonable person that the system has done ev- erything possible to minimize the pos- sibility of mistake. It is my opinion that this country is in dire need of the protection afforded to society by the death penalty amendment introduced by Senator D'Ar To. By Mr. MURKOWSKI: S. 2207. A bill to amend title 38, United States Code, to authorize the Administrator of Veterans' Affairs to provide assistance simians and dogs to veterans, who by reason of quadriple- gia, are entitled to disability compen- sation under laws administered by the Veterans' Administration. ASSISTANCE ANIMALS TO CERTAIN SEVERELY DISABLED VETERANS ? Mr. MURKOWSKI. Mr. President, I am most pleased to rise today to intro- duce a bill which will significantly im- prove the quality of life and increase the independence of certain severely disabled veterans. This bill would au- thorize the Veterans' Administration [VA] to provide assistive animals to certain quadriplegic veterans. These assistive animals include specially trained simians or canines. Mr. President, some 2,300 quadriple- gic veterans currently receive service- connected disability compensation from the VA. These veterans, disabled during military service, suffer from pa- ralysis affecting both arms and both legs. These veterans are referred to as "service-connected quadriplegics." I believe that these veterans-who are permanently disabled as a result of military service-deserve our highest priority. The Congress and the VA must continue to explore all op- tions which will assist these veterans in maximizing their independence and employment opportunities. I am pleased that the VA-with the assist- ance and support of the "Paralyzed Veterans of America"-has historically been in the forefront of innovative re- search, treatment, and rehabilitation activities relating to spinal cord inju- ries. Mr. President, last year the VA's general counsel was asked for its views as to whether the VA had the legal au- thority to provide certain veterans with specially trained simians, and in a November 6, 1987 opinion, the VA stated that "we do not find a satisfac- tory basis in law to provide these aides outside the research setting as a bene- fit to veterans." The opinion conclud- ed that specific statutory authority would be necessary to furnish simians to disabled veterans. Thus, to further the goal of achieving independence for disabled veterans, I am introducing today a bill which would authorize the VA to provide assistive animals to ser- vice-connected quadriplegics. Due to recent advances in medical technology, a quadriplegic who sur- vives the first year after injury has a nearly normal life expectancy. New technologies, among other things, have assisted quadriplegics in improv- ing their quality of life and provided for greater employment opportunities: A multitude of automobile adaptive equipment provides independence and opportunity; the Robotic Arm, an- other VA technological invention, can perform functional tasks by voice acti- vated control; computers operated by voice and "sip and puff" respiratory control have provided improved com- munication and job opportunities for many quadriplegics. Wheelchair im- provements have also dramatically in- creased the mobility of a quadriplegic. Today, there are wheelchairs for every lifestyle-including a variety of sports wheelchairs. According to Spinal Cord Injury: the Facts and Figures, 92 percent of all Americans with spinal cord injuries reside in private residences, generally at home with family members or friends who provide support and as- sistance. It is estimated that a quadri- plegic requires about 4 to 6 hours of human help daily. This assistance is provided by family members, friends, or a paid caregiver and includes activi- ties such as bathing, dressing, getting into and out of a wheelchair and other tasks. However, there are an endless number of small tasks with which the quadriplegic may need assistance. For the so-called "high level" quadriple- gic-that is, those with little or no use .of arms and no use of legs-tasks like turning off and on lights, food prepa- ration, opening and closing doors, re- S 2893 trieving a small object, and grooming are impossible to perform alone. The question we must address is the way in which helpful and cost-effective assist- ance can be provided to veterans to ac- complish these tasks. One answer-which has been shown to work-is to have certain types of animals perform these routine manual tasks. Research has indicated that cer- tain breeds of monkeys and dogs are well-suited for such a program. Since 1977, through combined fund- ing from the VA and the Paralyzed Veterans of America, a private sector organization known as "Helping Hands" has been conducting research relating to the training and use of monkeys to perform small tasks for quadriplegics. Dr. Mary Jane Willard, a behavioral psychologist and founder of "Helping Hands," noted that qua- driplegics who reside at.home general- ly have either too little or too much help. On one hand, a significant number of quadriplegics are left alone for large amounts of time. The quadri- plegic is lonely and often goes without basic necessities such as food and drink. For example, without a mouth- stick, a quadriplegic cannot turn the pages of a book or use the computer to work; if the mouthstick drops, there is no option but to wait until a time when someone can retrieve it for him. On the other hand, a family member may totally devote him or herself to the care of the quadriplegic, refusing to leave the house because of concerns that his or her loved one may need something. Either situation is terribly difficult and undesirable. It was with these considerations in mind that Dr. Willard. began to study the use of animals in performing rou- tine manual tasks for disabled persons. Research conducted by Dr. Willard and others has indicated that monkeys can be successfully trained to perform a multitude of tasks on verbal com- mand and with the use of a laser pointer. The first specially trained monkey was placed with a quadriplegic in 1979. The monkey's overall reliabil- ity in performing tasks has been 94 percent. Currently, seven quadriple- gics utilize monkeys to perform daily living tasks. In addition-to performing important tasks, the monkey also provides com- panionship to the sometimes lonely and isolated life of a quadriplegic. Re- search has indicated that the neigh- bors and community members were fascinated with the monkey and this fascination increased the opportunity for social interaction of the quadriple- gic. The monkey becomes the topic of communication much like discussions about pets or children often are among parents and pet owners. Re- search completed - in 1982 by Judith Zazula found that monkeys performed their tasks in a reliable and economic fashion and that the animal encour- aged interaction between the quadri- plegic and the nondisabled public. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2894 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE March 23, 1988 Equally as important, the owner de- rived personal satisfaction from the monkey. There are, of course, costs associated with training, equipping, and trans- porting each monkey. While the cost will decrease as the case load in- creases, "Helping Hands" estimates that if it can train and place 50 mon- keys annually, the one-time cost would be $11,000 each. The monkey has a working lifetime of 20 years. Disney World, Inc., has -spent nearly $100,000 in constructing a facility in Orlando, FL, to breed and raise monkeys for this project. Once established and run- ning at full speed, this will reduce the cost associated with this program. In addition, Mr. President, a Califor- nia-based nonprofit organization is in- volved with training dogs for use by disabled persons, including quadriple- gics. This organization, known as "Canine Companions for Independ- ence," was recognized in 1987 by the President's Committee on Employ- ment of the Handicapped with the Distinguished Service Award. This very important organization trains dogs to pull wheelchairs up inclines, retrive dropped items, and turn lights on and off. I am pleased that the Paralyzed Vet- erans of America have written to me to express their support for this im- portant legislation. I commend the fine work of the PVA in their efforts to provide greater independence for in- dividuals with spinal cord injuries. Mr. President, I urge my colleagues to join with me in support of this leg- islation. Mr. President; I ask unanimous con- sent that the research articles that I have discussed, the PVA letter, the VA's general counsel opinion on this matter, and the text of the bill be printed In.the RECORD. There being no objection, the mate- rial was ordered to be printed in the RECORD, as follows: S. 2207 Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the United - States of America in Congress assembled, SECTION 1. ASSISTIVE ANIMALS FOR CERTAIN DIS- ABLED VETERANS. (a) IN GENERAL.-Section 614 of title 38, United States Code, is amended by adding at the end the following new subsection: "(c) The Administrator may provide sim- ians and dogs specially trained as assistive animals to any veteran who, by reason of quadriplegia, is entitled to disability com- pensation, and may pay travel and inciden- tal expenses (under the terms and condi- tions set forth in section 111 of this title) to and-from such veteran's home that are in- curred in connection with the veteran be- coming adjusted to such simians or dogs, as the case may be.". (b) CLERICAL AMENDMENTS.-(1) The head- ing of section 614 of title 38, United States Code, is amended by striking out "seeing- eye dogs" and inserting in lieu thereof "as- sistive animals". (2) the table of sections at the beginning of chapter 17 of such title is amended by striking out the Item relating to section 614 and inserting in lieu thereof the following: "614. Fitting and training in use of prosthet- TRAINING A CAPUCHIN (CEBUS APELLA) TO PERFORM AS AN AIDE FOR A QUADRIPLEGIC' (By Mary Joan Willard, Karen Dana, Lori Stark, Jayne Owen, Judi Zazula, and Paul Corcoran) Abstract-Initial results of. a small pilot project indicate that Cebus monkeys have the potential to serve as animal aides for quadriplegics. During the course of the pilot project the investigators developed a set of procedures for teaching a Cebus monkey a variety of helping skills. Given a description of those procedures, a college student with no prior animal training experience was able to teach a naive Cebus apella nine dif- ferent complex behaviors in 25.5 hr of train- ing over a period of two months. INTRODUCTION Recent medical progress has permitted the survival of very severely disabled people who, although totally paralyzed, retain un- impaired cognitive and communication skills and in many cases also have a normal life expectancy. The most dramatic examples is the high level quadriplegic after a cervical spinal cord injury. In order to live independ- ently outside of a chronic care institution, such persons require a minimum of 4 to 5 hr per-day of human help, generally obtained by paying a "personal care attendant" (PCA). The PCA assists with tasks such as bathing, dressing, bowel and bladder rou- tines, household tasks and errands and transfers-into and out of a wheelchair. Many PCA's provide indispensible services and are highly motivated and, reliable. In other cases, however, dependence upon a PCA may be quite unsatisfactory. They are always hard to find, turnover is high, they may not arrive when scheduled, and in a few cases PCAs have exploited handicapped in- dividuals in various unfortunate ways. Fur- thermore, regardless of the quality of PCA- provided services, reliance upon a PCA Is quite expensive. The PCA represents a major expense for the handicapped individ- ual and/or the health care system. Since few quadriplegics can afford a full-time PCA, many spend. major portions of their waking hours unattended. In 1977 P. Corcoran and I began investi- gating the feasibility of training capuchin monkeys as helpers for the severely dis- abled. The target population we were inter- ested In includes disabled individuals who . are either totally paralyzed from the shoul- ders down or have only very limited use of their arms and legs. Most spinal-cord-in- jured persons as well as a small proportion of those with multiple sclerosis, muscular dystrophy or cerebral palsy- fall into this category. BACKGROUND AND SUBJECTS First Placement In 1979, after taming and working with several monkeys, we placed Hellion, a 2- year-old Cebus albifrons with Robert F., a 23-year-old man who is paralyzed from the shoulders down. Over the next 18 months experimental equipment was added to his electric wheelchair which enables him to now direct, reward and punish his trained capuchin. Robert uses a chin-controlled wheelchair to move about his apartment. A mini-laser pointer is mounted alongside the chin control. Robert communicates his needs by aiming the laser at the object he wishes Hellion to manipulate. He combines the laser beam with a verbal command to ' This research was funded by the Paralyzed Vet- erans of America and bay the National Science Foundation Grant No. PFR-800, 1938. the monkey. -When Hellion successfully completes a task, Robert rewards her by triggering the release of a food pellet from his wheelchair-mounted pellet dispenser. Because Hellion's natural curiosity could result in numerous messes in his apartment, a system was developed to prevent Hellion from destroying Robert's possessions. Hel- lion was trained to avoid all contact with pieces of furniture and miscellaneous per- sonal effects upon which white stickers had been placed. If she does touch a stickered item, Robert is able to punish her by deliv- ering either a warning tone or a tone plus an elecric shock to her tail. TABLE 1,.-TASKS AND PERFORMANCE RELIABILITY [in percent] Perform- arice - retiabil- m' 1. Monkey opens the refrigerator door, removes a covered plastic bowl and carries it to its owner's tray. Monkey then inserts bowl in a slot in the tray and removes the lid ................................ 94 2., Monkey removes a spoon from the feeding tray and feeds its owner. Owner requests each spoonful by making a clicking sound with his mouth ....................................................................... 98 3. Monkey opens the refrigerator door, removes a bottle filled with juice and carries it to the table. Monkey then inserts the bottle into a slot in the tray, removes the plastic lid and inserts a straw into the opening...... ............................................................ 95 4. Monkey removes the empty bowl, and/or bottle from the tray and deposits it in a trash can .......................................................... 88 5. Monkey places tape cassette into a tape recorder so that the cassette is correctly positioned for use............................................ 100 6. Monkey retrieves a mouthstick and ey -places the correct end in its owner's mouth ............................................................................. 100 7. Monkey opens the bedroom door, which is then made accessible to the owner in his wheechair ......................................... 100 8. Monkey turns a light switch on or off ........................................... 87 9. Monkey activates a mini-vacuum cleaner (modified battery- operated "dustbuster") and pushes it wherever the laser indicates. Monkey then returns it to its housing and turns it off.... 50 10. Monkey retrieves a dust rag and dusts wherever the laser indicates ............................................................................................ 100 11. Monkey brushes the hair of its owner using a soft-bristled hairbrush ........................................................................................... 88 12. Monkey moves objects from place to place following the laser beam ........................................ :........................................................ 100 13. Monkey pushes the mounth and chin control arm on the wheelchair within reach of its owner ............................................... 100 14. Monkey sits on the lap of its owner on command ........................ 97 15. Monkey returns to its cage on command and shuts the door after entering, thereby locking the cage door .................................. 100 ' A connect trial was one in which the monkey began the desired behavior within 15 sec. of the initial command. Two hundred and seventy-two behaviors were requested from the monkey over a period of 4 days. Two hundred and fifty-seven behaviors were correctly completed giving the monkey an overall reliability of 94 percent. Hellion can perform a variety of tasks for her paralyzed owner. Table 1 lists these tasks and the reliability with which they are performed. The General Problem The training strategies used in teaching Hellion were based upon the principles of behavior modification (Skinner, 1938, 1951; Honig & Staddon, 1977). Although these basic principles of learning provided a guide, working out the step-by-step procedures for teaching specific tasks involved a consider- able amount of trial and error. What we felt we needed was a standard set of procedures which could be used by almost anyone to teach a tame Cebus monkey some basic helping skills. Such a set of procedures would allow inexpensive replications of the results we had achieved with Hellion. What follows is a description of those procedures as they were used by an inexperienced train- er to teach a "naive" monkey a basic set of skills. Su Su is an 8-year-old female Cebus apella. Work with two Cebus apellas and four Cebus albifrons led the investigators to conclude that apellas have an activity level roughly one-fourth that of the more acro- batic and somewhat hyperactive albifrons. The attention span of the-apella also ap- pears to be much longer. The phlegmatic Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE temperament of the apella suggests that they will make significantly better animal aides. Su Su was purchased from a zoo where she had lived for two years: Although she had been a pet prior to her placement in the zoo, the details of her pre-zoo life are un- known. After she was purchased, all of her teeth were extracted, thereby eliminating any possibility that she might bite her trainer or future owner. She then lived for several months in the home of a volunteer who spent approximately 1 hr with her each day, accustoming her to close contact with humans. When she began her training in January of 1981, she had become a tame and friendly animal. The Trainer Kathy is a 21-year-old college student who volunteered to train a monkey. She had worked for one year as a veterinary's assist- ant but had no animal training experience. Kathy was given a 50-page manual of train- ing instructions. She was supervised on an "as needed" basis. Kathy received a total of 2 hrs of assistance from an experienced trainer, primarily in the initial stages of training. TRAINING PROCEDURES Training Room The sight or sound of people walking or talking easily disrupted the early training. Therefore, initially a 25-ft square window- less closet was used as the training site. Once a behavior had been mastered, howev- er, extraneous. auditory and visual stimuli were far less disruptive, and the later stages of training were conducted in a large but sparsely furnished office. Food Deprivation and Rewards Su Su was deprived of food for approxi- mately 16 hr before each training session. Small amounts of peanut butter or bananas were then used to reward Su Su for success- ful performance during the session. The Sessions Sessions varied in length from 20 to 60 min. The average session was 35 min. Typi- cally trainer and monkey spent at least 90 percent of their time on task behavior. If the monkey appeared distracted, confused, or not hungry the session was discontinued and rescheduled. Approximately 15 percent of the sessions had to be rescheduled. Conditioned Reinforcer Skinner (1951) noted that optimal learn- ing occurs when a reinforcer follows the target behavior within two-fifths of a second. Following Skinner's suggestion the trainer repeatedly paired the sound of a clicker noisemaker with the delivery of a small amount of food. Approximately 100 such pairings took place over the course of two 20-min sessions. By the end of the second session the monkey would look toward the trainer and approach her when- ever she sounded the clicker. The trainer then used this same noise in subsequent training to give immediate feedback to the monkey. It was followed by a bit of food a few seconds later. Imitation The first training objective was to teach the monkey to imitate the trainer in per- forming a simple task. The trainer gave the command "do this" and simultaneously dropped a rubber stopper into a 20X8 inch shallow box. Initially the monkey was re- warded if she merely touched the stopper. The trainer then repeated the desired be- havior and rewarded successive approxima- tions until the monkey consistently picked up and dropped the stopper into the box when given the command. The large box was replaced with a smaller box and then, after several more correct trials, with a bowl 8 inches in diameter. The monkey was con- sidered, to have mastered the task when nine out of ten trials were correct. It took 18 min for Su Su to master this first task. The trainer next substituted a plastic lid for. the stopper and rewarded the monkey for placing this new object in the bowl. After several successful trials she set both the lid and the stopper before the monkey some 18 inches apart. The trainer now se- lected one or the other of these two objects, dropping it into the bowl as she said "do this." The trainer then replaced the object and waited for the monkey to imitate her. The monkey was ignored for 30 sec (a "time out") if either the incorrect object or both objects were selected. The trainer then re- peated the demonstration. If the monkey se- lected the correct object, the trainer imme- diately sounded the clicker but withheld the food reward until the monkey also dropped the object into the bowl. Once the monkey demonstrated the con- sistent ability to discriminate between the two objects and imitate the trainer's ac- tions, a third object was added and the proc- ess begun once again. Through further imi- tation of the trainer, the monkey was even- tually taught to select one of five different objects and place it in one of two different bowls. The monkey took a total of 135 min in mastering this imitation task, and an ad- ditional 45 min was spent in practice and review. Fetching Su Su next learned to retrieve a small object and place it in the trainer's hand. In teaching this task, the trainer took advan- tage of a skill Su Su had already acquired. The trainer began by giving the command "do this" and then dropped a rubber stop- per into a small bowl. After the monkey had correctly imitated this behavior several times, the trainer cupped her hand inside the bowl. The monkey was then rewarded each time she placed the stopper into this hand/bowl combination. Once the monkey was performing the task without hesitation, the bowl was removed. The monkey was now rewarded for imitat- ing the trainer in placing the stopper into the trainer's cupped hand. After the monkey had done this several times success- fully, the trainer changed command from "do this" to "fetch." After several more suc- cessful.trials, the imitative stimulus was dis- continued, and the trainer simply prompted the fetching behavior by touching or point- ing to the stopper while saying "fetch" as she extended her other hand. Because the fetching response was often carelessly performed, the trainer began to withhold reinforcement if the stopper fell out of her outstretched hand. In these in- stances, the monkey was required to pick up the stopper again and place it in the open hand before receiving a reward. Next, the trainer varied the location of the stopper, although at no time was it placed more than a few feet from the trainer. Once the monkey had been trained to per- form. this task reliably, the trainer substi- tuted a series of small objects for the stop- per, one at a time, until the monkey would retrieve any small object placed within the immediate vicinity of the trainer. Su Su mastered this task within 17 min. Fetching in Response to the Laser Beam For this task, the trainer began by reduc- ing the light in the training room by substi- tuting a 15-watt bulb for the normal 100- watt light. She then placed the rubber stop- per on the floor and directed a flashlight beam at it. Extending her hand palm-up, she gave the command to "fetch." After sev- S 2895 eral successful trials, the trainer substituted a lid for the stopper and again directed the flashlight beam at this new target. Once the monkey had retrieved this second object several times, the trainer placed. both ob- jects on the floor 18 inches apart and direct- ed the flashlight at one of them. She gave the command to "fetch", with her out- stretched hand held equidistant between the two objects. If the monkey chose the lighted object, she was immediately reward- ed. If she selected the incorrect object, the trainer withdrew her hand and the flash- light and ignored the monkey for 30 sec. Once Su Su was consistently retrieving the lighted object, a 0.5 milliwatt helium neon laser was substituted for the flash- light. The laser projected a 1/9 inch diameter bright red dot onto the target. The monkey first spent several minutes trying to eat the dot, but then began to retrieve the object upon which the dot rested. Additional ob- jects were added and trials given until the monkey could retrieve the correct object from among a dozen placed about the room. It took Su Su 145 min to master this task. Another 120 min were spent practicing this task in a variety of settings. Changing the Location of Small Objects Su Su was next taught to pick up a small object and move it to locations indicated by the laser beam. Once again, parts of an old task were used to teach this new task. The trainer first had the monkey retrieve a rubber stopper highlighted by the laser beam. This was repeated several times. The trainer then substituted the command "change" for "fetch" and simultaneously moved the laser beam from the stopper to her outstretched hand the moment the monkey picked up the stopper. After several successful trials in which Su Su transferred the stopper to the trainer's hand, the trainer substituted a shoe box for her hand. She again aimed the laser at the location to which the monkey was to trans- port the object. After several trials in which the monkey correctly picked up the stopper, carried it over, and placed it in the shoe box, the lid of the shoe box was substituted for the box itself. Later a piece of cardboard was substituted for the lid. Still later the size of the target was reduced even further as the cardboard was torn in half, and then into quarters. Finally the cardboard was re- moved entirely, leaving the beam of light on the floor (directly in front of the trainer) as the only clue to where the stopper was to be placed. After several successful trials in which the monkey transferred the stopper to the lighted spot, the trainer increased the diffi- culty of the task by requiring the monkey to move the stopper approximately a foot to her left or to her right. The monkey was not rewarded until she had placed the stop- per directly in the path of the beam. Other small objects were later substituted for the stopper, one at a time, so that the monkey was given the opportunity to move any one of the variety of objects from one spot on the floor to another. Su Su mastered this skill in 120 min. An- other 95 min were spent practicing this newly-mastered task in a variety of settings, which included instances of placing objects on top of pieces of furniture. Removing a Plastic Bottle from a Refrigera- tor, Placing It in a Slot on a Feeding Tray, Opening the Lid and Inserting a Straw For this chain of tasks, the last step was taught first, then the next to the last step, and so on until the monkey had mastered the entire sequence. The last step is inserting a straw into an open container. The trainer slid the bottle Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 S 2896 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE into Its slot in the feeding tray and began by demonstrating a modified version of the target behavior. She . inserted a 3 inch length of straw into the opening and re- warded the monkey for successful imita- tions. The trainer gradually increased the length of the straw until the monkey could insert a 12 inch length of plastic without difficulty. The next to the last step in the chain was removing the lid from the bottle. Because the monkey was to do this only when the bottle was properly Inserted into its holder, the bottle was always inserted into the feed- ing tray before the monkey was given the opportunity to unscrew the lid. The trainer first tightened the lid slightly and then demonstrated the twisting motion necessary to unscrew it. At first the monkey was rewarded for any twisting action, even if it did not result in removing the lid. During any trials in which she removed the lid, the monkey was given the plexiglass straw and required to insert it in the bottle before receiving her reward. The rightness with. which the lid was at- tached was gradually increased until she demonstrated the ability to unfasten a se- curely closed top. Because the 12 oz square container was to be inserted into a square slot in the tray, the monkey was able to grip the lid with both hands and to exert the force necessary to unscrew the top without also turning the bottle. The third from the last step in the chain was inserting the square bottle into its proper slot. A square opening 1.5 times as large as the bottle was cut into the bottom of a shoe box. When inverted, the box pre- sented an opening into which the bottle could easily be guided. The trainer demon- strated the desired behavior and rewarded the monkey for successful imitations. Once she had mastered this, the size of the open- ing was gradually reduced until the monkey could guide the bottle into a snug enclosure without difficulty. The actual opening in the feeding tray was then substituted for the shoe box. Every time the monkey successfully dropped the bottle into the slot in the feed- ing tray, the trainer required that the monkey then unscrew the lid and insert the straw before she gave the monkey her reward. When necessary, the trainer prompted the monkey to complete the entire chain of these behaviors by simply tapping the lid or straw to draw the mon- key's attention to the next step in the se- quence. The last step in the training process was removing the bottle from a refrigerator and carrying it to the table in preparation for inserting it into the feeding tray. The train- er first placed the bottle 2 ft from the feed- ing tray on the table and rewarded the monkey when she completed the chain from that point. Next the trainer placed ? the bottle on a chair next to the table and re- quired the monkey to pick it up, place it on top of the table, and follow through in car- rying it to the tray. Finally the bottle was placed on the floor several feet from the chair. If the monkey hesitated, the trainer prompted her behavior by directing the laser beam in front of the monkey to indi- cate where she was to go. Opening the refrigerator door was made easy by placing several strips of tape across the magnetic lock. Seated on the floor, the trainer gave the command "do this" while placing her fingers in the door crack. She then gently pried the door open. The monkey was rewarded for successful imita- tions. The strips of tape were gradually re- moved one at a time until the monkey could brace herself and tug open a securely closed door. Once she was proficient at this task, every instance of opening the door was fol- lowed by the trainer directing a laser beam at the bottle located on the bottom shelf. She was required to complete the entire chain before receiving a reward. Small amounts of liquid were added to the bottle until Su Su could easily. carry and manipu- late the container when it held 12 oz of liquid. Su Su mastered the entire chain in 240 min. An additional 55 min. were spent in practice and review. Su Su was also taught to retrieve a bowl with a detachable lid and a sandwich holder and place them in their proper slots in the feeding tray. Because the training proce- dures so closely resemble those followed in teaching her to retrieve and position a bottle in the feeding tray, they will not be described here. Su Su mastered retrieving, positioning and opening the bowl in 40 min. She learned to transport and position the sandwich holder in 40 min. RETRIEVING A MOUTHSTICK Many quadriplegics use a mouthstlck to type, operate a speaker phone, and turn the pages of a book. If this tool is dropped, they are unable to retrive it without assistance. Su Su was taught to retrieve a mouthstick from the trainer's lap or from the floor. The trainer began by sitting in a chair at a desk and placing the monkey on the desk top. The trainer then held a pencil with one end wrapped in tape several inches from her open mouth. She said "do this" and inserted the taped end into her mouth. Next, con- tinuing to hold the pencil lightly, the train- er waited for the monkey to touch the pencil and then guided it into her ovm mouth. The trainer gradually decreased the amount of guidance she provided until the monkey would insert the mouthstick into the trainer's mouth on her own. The trainer slowly_ increased the distance between her own mouth and where she placed the pencil until the monkey was able to pick it up from the desk and properly insert it. If at any time the monkey at- tempted to insert the untaped end in first, the trainer closed her mouth and refused to accept it, and instead gently turned the pencil around in the monkey's hands, prompting her to try again. The task was considered to have been mastered when the trainer was able to drop the mouthstick on the desk, her lap, or the floor, give the com- mand "mouth," and have the monkey prop- erly retrieve it. Su Su mastered this task in 25 min. Another 25 min was spent in review. Dusting Furniture or Cleaning Up Small Spills For, this task, the monkey was taught to push a dust cloth along a flat surface fol- lowing a laser beam. The trainer began by inserting her hand into a cotton potholder mitten and placing the mitten on the floor. Giving the command "do this," she then pushed the mitten with her other hand, sliding it several inches across the floor. At first the monkey was rewarded for touching the mitten. If the monkey at- tempted to pick it up, the trainer pressed it tightly against the floor. The monkey could now only employ a sliding motion to move it. As more of the monkey's attempts took the form of pushing movements, the trainer withdrew her hand from the mitten. Once the monkey was consistently able to push the cloth several inches, the trainer in- troduced the laser beam as a target. The beam was directed a few inches in front of the mitten. The monkey had only to push the mitten a very short distance before it intercepted the light. As soon as the mitten did cross the beam, the trainer immediately sounded the clicker. The distance between the beam and the mitten was gradually in- March 23, 1988 creased until the monkey had learned first to look for the beam and then to push the cloth toward it. The trainer then began to move the beam, requiring that the monkey follow it back and forth across the floor sev- eral times before receiving a reward. It took 45 min for the monkey to master this task. Another 30 min were spent in practicing it on various surfaces. Vacuuming A small non-electric carpet sweeper was modified for use by the monkey. Seated on the floor, the trainer began by placing her leg across the base of the sweeper leaving only the T-bar handle accessible. Saying "do this," the trainer placed both of her hands on the handle. The monkey was rewarded if she placed one or both hands in the same position. Once the monkey had learned to position her hands correctly, the trainer re- moved her leg from the base of the sweeper. Saying "do this," the trainer now pushed against the handle until the sweeper had moved several inches. The monkey was ini- tially rewarded. for any forward pushing, but the distance she was required to travel before receiving a reward was gradually in- creased. If the monkey stopped short of the desired distance the trainer prompted a second or third push by tapping the handle and giving the command "vac." Once the monkey had learned to push the sweeper several feet consistently, the laser .beam was introduced as a target. As in teaching dusting, the trainer directed the beam 1 to 2 ft in front of the monkey and sounded the clicker the moment the clean- ing instrument intersected the beam. Once the monkey had learned to readily follow the beam in a straight line, the trainer began to direct the beam in a wide arc. She gradually increased the sharpness of the turns until the monkey could follow the beam back and forth across the floor with- out difficulty. Su Su mastered this task in 230 min. An additional 80 min were spent In review and practice under a variety of condi- tions. CONCLUSION Thus far Su Su has spent 25.5 hr in train- ing. Her education is still incomplete. Over the next few months she will be (1) taught to avoid any pieces of furniture on which white stickers have been pasted; (2) trained in several obedience behaviors via avoidance conditioning; (3) trained to use a specially designed toilet which is part of her cage; and (4) given 20 to 40 hr Of supervised prac- tice in the home of her new quadriplegic owner. It is yet too early to evaluate the costs and benefits associated with owning a simian aide. Cebus monkeys do, however, have a life expectancy of 30 years, which means they should be able to serve their owners over a very long period of time. The costs associated at least with the laboratory stage of training are surprisingly low. Kathy's training of Su Su demonstrates that even an inexperienced volunteer is capable of achieving sophisticated results with the proper set of instructions. Should simian aides prove practical, our long term goal is to establish a non-profit program similar to a guide-dog school. How- ever, a number of questions need to be an- swered before such a project can be under- taken. They include: (1) Does the gender of the monkey affect its performance as an aide? (2) Should the males undergo castra- tion or the females ovariotomies? If so at what age? (3) At what age should a monkey be removed from a breeding colony to be raised by humans? (4) Is there a small monkey suitable than the Cebus apelia to act as a helper for quadriplegics? Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 6 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -- SENATE Areas we are now.working on include: (1) refining and standardizing the equipment used by a manlmonkey team; 42) developing a ,comprehensive list of behaviors useful to quadriplegics -which monkeys are capable of performing; .(3) refining the procedures used in the later stages of training, Including the transfer of control from a trainer to a dis- abled owner; and (4) training and placing a sufficient number. of monkeys with disabled owners that we can evaluate the costs and benefits associated with using a simian aide. The capuchins s potential to help the par- alyzed is exciting. As man and monkey work together :daily constantly practicing old tasks and occasionally adding :new ones, the resulting symbiotic relationship promises to be a unique andincreasingly -complex one. ACS NO NL'EDGEMEN4a5 Kathleen Waugh attends the University of Massachusetts. Throughout the training program her patience and good humor in- spired us When we most needed encourage- ment. It is impossible to express our debt to her. REFERENCES Honig, W. &. J. E. R. Staddon (eds.), 1977. "Handbook of Operant Behavior." Prentice- Hall, New Jersey. Skinner, B.F., 1938. "The Behavior of Or- ganisms: An Experimental Analysis." Apple- ton-Century-Crofts, New York. 1951..13ow to teach animals. Set. Amer-,185: 26- 29. A CAPUCHIN MONKEY AS AN AIDE TO A QUAD- RIPLEGIC INDIVIDUAL: AN INITIAL EVALUA- TION (Judith Lee Zazula, Tufts University Master Thesis, 1982) 'ABSTRACT In a previous Pilot study, a capuchin monkey .was trained to retrieve objects, acti- vate household appliances, and feed a human being. The purpose of this study was to evaluate the effectiveness of the use of that monkey as a supplementary aide to a quadriplegic young man. The intent was to determine if monkey assistance would be an effective method of increasing a handi- capped individual's ability to interact with his environment. The evaluation Was divided into the areas of (a) task performance, (b) attitudes toward the disabled, (c) undersirable monkey behaviors, (d) cost effectiveness, and (e) the disabled owner's.subjenlve ap- praisal. Data collection methods included personal interviews, observation during baseline and experimental periods trine in- volving the monkey and one not), and a record review. The results indicate that task behaviors of the quadriplegic individual increased -when he received assistance from his animal aide. More people were found to initiate verbal interaction with the human subject in public when he was :accompanied by the monkey. Specific annoying behaviors that the animal engaged in were identified by the disabled owner and his human attend- ant. Additionally, the estimated cast of monkey assistance in feeding was less- than the cost of human assistance in the same ac- tivity. The disabled owner's subjective ap- praisal revealed that the use of a monkey aide had an overall positive effect on his aged interaction between its disabled owner and the nondisabled public, negative monkey behaviors were tolerable, and the human subject derived personal satisfaction from his simian aide. The findings of . this initial evaluation imply,that the use of a capuchin monkey as an aide to,a quadriplegic individual is a fea- sible method of supplementing the assist- anceprovided `by a part time human attend- ant. CAPUCHIN MONKEYS AS AmEs FOR 'QUADRIPLEGICS _ (Mary Joan Willard, Ed.D, and Paul Corcoran,'M;D.) - Pilot project research has shown that.cap- uchin monkeys have the potential to be .as valuable to high-level quadriplegics as guide dogs are now to the blind. Current .goals and the progress made on each Is as .follow:s: 1. The standardization of training proce- dures for teaching monkeys a basic reper- toire of skills. Approximately two-thirds of the training procedures used in teaching a basic repertoire of skills have been -stand- ardized, and are described Ina 100-page Il- lustrated training manual. By .following ,the Instructions in this manual, inexperienced college students have successfully trained naive monkeys with only occasional help from a training supervisor. 2. The redesign of equipment which allows the disabled user to direct, reward, and punish his animal helper. The shock/buzz remote-control harnesses used to discipline the monkeys have been reduced in size and weight. A variable-level shock control has been added to the unit. Powder reward dis- pensers which frequently clogged have been replaced with inexpensive manually operat- ed liquid-reward dispensers. 3. A directory of new skills which can be taught to monkeys. Only four new behav- iors have been added to the 'basic list. It seems as if most high-level quadriplegics share many of the same basic needs. 4. Placement of 3-4 monkeys,per year with new owners. Three additional placements have been made since June of 1982. Feed- back has resulted in a better understanding of the type of situation in which these animal aides can be'of most value. 5. The evaluation of all placements. A pro- posal is being prepared for submission to the VA Prosthetic and Sensory Aids Service requesting an independent evaluation - of simian aides. B. A cost/benefit analysis. for the disabled recipient and the health care system. Pre- liminary results indicate the financial and psychosocial benefits derived from owning a simian aide outweigh the costs. A more formal analysis awaits data that will be col- lected during the Independent evaluation. I. An analysis of the type of organization Which can train and place simian aides on a larger scale. A detached outline -of an orga- nization has not only been drawn up, but es- tablished. Helping Hands. Simian Aides for the Disabled, Inc. was incorporated in New York State in October of 1382 as a nonprof- it organization. THE PSYCHOSOCIAL IMPACT?OF SIMIAN AIDES ON QUADRIPLEGICS (M.J. Willard, Alice Levee, and Lauren Westbrook) ABSTRACT In 1977 Willard and Cocoran began inves- tigating the feasibility of training capuchin monkeys' as sides for quadriplegics. Their throughout the day without having to rely on human assistance. By 1984, seven quadri- plegics were living and working with simian aides. These individuals had not only achieved greater independence, but they re- ported a variety of psychological and social changes. Tame, affectionate capuchins pro- S 2897 vided companionship and :recreation. The quadriplegics', social -world expanded as their monkeys attracted strangers and en- tertained .riends.71ie :simian aides seemed to hold'a"position in their owners affections somewhere between? that of a treasured pet and a human child. BACKGROUND ON THE'PROBLEM To live outside -of a chronic care institu- tion, a high level quadriplegic requires a minimum of 4 to ,6 hours per day of human help. The disabled Individual usually re- ceives this help from one or more family members. Twho must snake drastic changes in their own lives to provide it, or from a paid personal care attendant (PCA). The relative or PCA assists with tasks such as bathing, dressing, bowel :and bladder routines, house- hold tasks, and transfers into and oat of a wheelchair. In addition to these essential tasks, which are usually performed in the morning -and again at night, a quadriplegic needs help to achieve countless small tasks during the course of the day. Putting a book or ,maga- zine on a -reading stand, placing -a cassette into a tap recorder, getting a drink, eating a meal, retrieving a fallen mouthsttck, and opening a door are .all tasks that require as- sistance. Few quadriplegics have families willing 4or able to Provide constant access to help, and fewer .still can afford full-time paid attend- ants. Many simply do ;without. These indi- viduals are surviving, but the quality of their'lives leaves room for a great deal of improvement. , SIMIAN AIDES . in 197.9, after training and working with several monkeys, Willard and Cocoran placed Hellion, a 2-year-old CCebus albs ronms' with .Robert F., a.23-year-old man who is paralyzed from the shoulders down. Robert lives in his own apartment with the aid oof a PCA. His live-in attendant works full time at a nearby hospital and Robert is alone ap- proximately 9 hours per day. 5 days per week. To communicate his needs to his 16--pound animal aide, Robert aims a small harmless laser pointer at the object he wants her to manipulate. The laser is mounted on the chin control mechanism of his wheelchair. He uses the laser beam plus a verbal com- mand to .indicate what the animal is to do With the object. When Hellion has complet- ed a task, Robert rewards her with the re- lease-of a food pellet from the dispenser mounted on his wheelchair. In addition to the tasks. illustrated, Hel- lion -can retrieve a fallen mouthstiek and place the correct end in Robert's mouth. She can remove a sandwich- held in a sand- wich holder from the refrigerator and place it on a tray allowing Robert to eat. Should he want a drink, she can place a drink con- tainer on the feeding tray, open it, and insert a straw. She can turnlights on or off or use a rag to clean up spills and dust fur- niture. Because she can move small objects from place to place following a laser beam. Robert can-direct Hellion to place selected books on a reading stand or throw waste- papers in the trash. She will come when called and return to her cage, locking the door behind her when given a command to do so. - TRAINING TECHNIQUES The training - tractegies used in teaching Hellion were based upon, the principles of behavior: modification. Alt - igh these basic principles of learning provided a guide, working nut the step-by-step procedures for teaching specific tasks involved a consider- able amount of trial.:and'error. All-but two Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 S 2898 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD - SENATE behaviors are maintained using reward alone. The exceptional behaviors, returning to the cage and avoiding marked objects and areas, must be performed with 100% reli- ability and, therefore, are maintained through threat of punishment. Robert can deliver a warning tone or a warning tone and a mild electric shock to the base of Hel- lion's tail if she disobeys these two com- mands. PSYCHOSOCIAL IMPACT Initially, we were more concerned with the practical aspects of simian aide usage. The 7 placements made over the past 5 years have allowed us to experiment with new behaviors, and with the species, age, and sex of the monkeys. They have also led to equipment refinement and the develop- ment of improved training techniques. This work had led us to conclude that simian aides can be cost effective, reliable, and very appropriate helpers for some portion of the quadriplegic population. Despite our task-oriented focus, it has become increasingly apparent that these animals are providing much more than a means to increase independence. In examin- ing the literature on pet therapy, we found that the psychosocial impact of animals on the aged, imprisoned, and the handicapped has been explored. Observations made on the quadriplegic/simian interactions have convinced us that this partnership repre- sents one of the most unique and dramatic illustrations of the human/animal bonding phenomena. Numerous studies on the theraputic uses of pets have documented the psychological changes that can occur with the acquisition of a pet. Lima State Hospital for the Crimi- nally Insane uses pets as catalysts for ther- apy. This treatment has been effective with depressed, suicidal, and introverted patients Lee (1982) reports that the pets alleviate loneliness, hopelessness, and boredom, while simultaneously increasing self-esteem and stimulating a less self-focused and a more responsible attitude in the patients. Feld- mann (1977) reports that responsibility for the welfare of a pet can help the owner feel significant, nurturing, and needed. Upon re- ceiving her simian aide, a 35-year-old quadri- plegic told her sister. "I feel as if I'm getting the child I never thought I'd be able to have." Fox (1981) and Levison (1970, 1972) have studied the effects of pets on the elderly and found that the major benefits of the pet/owner relationship include companion- ship, affection, stimulation, and emotional security. Even more so than the elderly, high-level quadriplegics are restricted in the activities they can engage in. Much of their time is spent at home, where rooms are wheelchair accessible, adaptive equipment is set up, and a daily routine of human assist- ance is provided. Such confinement often leads to isolation and loneliness. The mother of a 27-year-old quadriplegic partici- pant observed. He was hurt 5 years ago. His friends gradually stopped coming around. There's just his family now, and that monkey. They do everything together. I can't tell you how much she means to him. The animal aides are working creatures who demand active owners. A quadriplegic must direct, reward, and discipline his monkey many times during the day. Main- taining task performance, dealing with be- havior problems, and teaching new tasks are complex skills which require attentiveness, creativity, and problem-solving. This mental and emotional stimulation can help allevi- ate the boredom and depression associated with isolation and restricted activities. March 23, 1988 were neutral but over a period of months have become very attached to her. The sixth attendant did not like her H but now tolerates her, and the seventh person dis- liked her from day one: She quit. Simian aides can also contribute to the richness of these on-going relationships. One full time attendant said of his employ- er, He is not always the most stimulating person. We just can't have that much in common. But that monkey has kept us to- gether. We talk about her all the time: about the cute things she does and how other people react to her. Whenever anyone calls or stops by, they ask about H. (the monkey). He (my employer) has a million funny stories to tell and people love to hear them. More than one observer has commented on the obvious pride a quadriplegic takes in his simian aide. Ownership itself is part of the source. They possess something unusual that others want to touch, admire. and play with. Their own expertise is another source of pride. They have become knowledgeable about primate training, care, and personali- ty. Others seek them out, valuing their in- formation and showing genuine interest in their stories. It is fairly recent medical progress which has permitted the survival of these severely disabled people. As of 1979 there were 75,000 spinal cord injured quadriplegics in the United States, and every year the number grows. Over 80% of those injured are under 40 years of age. In many cases these individuals have a normal life expect- ancy. Society is just beginning to provide for more than custodial care. Simian Aides are one option which not. only helps with daily care, but has profound effects on the quality of their lives as well. ACKNOWLEDGMENTS This work was supported by the Veterans Administration and the Dodge Foundation. REFERENCES Dejong, G. and Wenker, T. (1979) Amen- dant care as a prototype independent living service. Archives of Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation 60:477-462. Feldmann, B.M. (1977) Why people own pets. In: The Handbook of Animal Welfare Biomedical Psychological and Ecological As- pects of Pet Problems and Control, Allen, W. and Westbrook, L. (eds.), Gerald STM Press, New York. Fox, M. (1981) Relationships between the human and nonhuman animals. In: Interre- lationships Between People and Pets. Fogle, S. (ed), Thomas, Springfield, Illinois. Goffman, E. (1963) Stigma: Notes on the Management of Spoiled Identity. Prentice- Hall, Englewood Cliffs, New Jersey. Hunt, P. (1966) Stigma. Geoffrey Chap- man Ltd., London. Lee, D. (1982), Lima State Hospital Pet Therapy Program, private correspondence. Levinson, B.M. (1970) Nursing home pets: a psychological adventure for the patient. Part I The National Humane Review 58 (455): 14-16. Levinson, B.M. (1972) Pets and Human Development, Thomas, Springfield, Illinois. Marinelli, R. and Dell-Orto, A. (Eds.), (1977) Psychological and Social Impact of Physical Disability, Springer, New York. Roessler, R. and Bolton, B. (1978) Psycho- logical Adjustment to Disability, University Park Press, Baltimore. Shontz, F.C. (1974) The Psychological As- pects of Physical Illness and Disability, Macmillan, New York. Smith-Hanen, S. (1976) Socialization of the physically handicapped. Journal of Ap- plied Rehabilitation Counseling. 7: 131-141. Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005ROO1300070005-1 In a study examining attending care for the disabled, DeJong and Wenker (1979) found that self-management of even a small part of one's personal care was critical to a sense of self-worth. and independence. Shontz (1975) found that individuals who control their own life experiences maintain a higher morale than those who feel totally controlled by outside events. A quadriplegic is dependent upon his family and attend- ants for everything from bowel and bladder care to each bite of food he consumes. It is an unusual person who is comfortable with asking for help 20, 30, or 40 times per day. Feelings of imposition and helplessness are not part of the monkey/quadriplegic re- lationship. Controlling a wheelchair-mount- ed food dispenser gives the quadriplegic power. The monkey is eager to perform, knowing she will be immediately reinforced. Thus the quadriplegic enjoys the role of di- rector and benefactor. All owners have re- ported playing fetch and reward games with their animal aides. Much as a dog owner might throw a stick for his pet whenever chores are not needed, quadriplegics direct and reward for the fun of it. A part-time at- tendant for a quadriplegic observed that her employer had less trouble keeping attend- ants now that she has a simian aide. Instead of giving us orders for every little thing she'd ask the monkey to do some- thing. It seems to meet some of her needs for control, and it made life a lot easier for us. SOCIAL BENEFITS The difficulty experienced by the disabled in meeting people is well documented (Mari- belil and Dell-Orto, 1977; Roessler and Bolton, 1978; and Smith-Hanen, 1976). Strangers feel guilty and uncomfortable in the presence of the handicapped (Goffman, 1963) and as a result generally avoid interac- tion with them. Such avoidance exacerbates the isolation and loneliness suffered by many handicapped people, and may encour- age further social withdrawal (Hunt, 1966). Animals give others an acceptable reason to make contact and ease the awkward initial. interaction. Each of the 7 participants in this program have spontaneously comment- ed on the effect their monkeys have in at- tracting others. One quadriplegic said. Whenever I'm lonely, I go outside with my monkey. Everybody thinks she's beautiful and wants to know all about her. In a study by J.L. Zazula in 1982, ap- proach behavior toward a quadriplegic with and without his monkey was assessed by measuring the number of people who initi- ated conversation with the quadriplegic in a public shopping center in the absence of the monkey, only 2 strangers spoke to the quad- riplegic within a period of one hour. Howev- er, with a monkey seated in his lap, 71 strangers initiated a conversation with the owner within a one-hour period. In fact, Zazula reports that her quadriplegic subject chose whether to bring his monkey on a public excursion or into his front yard, de- pending on how much attention he felt like receiving that day. Monkeys not only attract attention, but their presence can minimize the salience of their owner's handicap. With little atten- tion being paid to his paralysis, a qaudriple- gic is free to express his own individuality. This is no small achievement for someone who must deal each day with other people's prejudices concerning the handicapped. Most, though not all, relationships are im- proved by the acquisition of a simian aide. One participant spoke. of the mixed and evolving reactions of her 7 part-time attend- ants, Two immediately loved H. (the monkey) and thought she was a great help. Three Declassified and Approved For Release 2012/08/28: CIA-RDP90M00005R001300070005-1 March 23, 1988 CONGRESSIONAL RECORD -- SENATE S 2899 Zazula, J. (1982) A capuchin monkey as an aide to a quadriplegic individual: Animal evaluation, Masters Thesis, Tufts Universi- ty. THE USE OF CAPUCHIN MONKEYS AS AIDES TO QUADRIPLEGICS BACKGROUND ON QUADRIPLEGICS Recent medical progress has permitted the survival of very severely disabled people who, although totally paralyzed, have normal cognitive and communication skills. In many cases, severely disabled individuals also have a normal life expectancy. The most dramatic example Is the high level spinal 'cord injured quadriplegic who is para- lyzed, in varying degrees, from the shoul- ders down. As of 1979, 'here were 75,000 spinal cord injured quadriplegics in the United States. Eighty-two percent of them were men and most were young. Fifty per- cent were between the ages of 15 and 25 at the time of their injury (Nat. Spinal Cord Injury Data Research Center, 1979). To live outside of a chronic -care institu- tion, a high level quadriplegic typically re- quires a minimum of four to six hours a day of human help. The disabled individual usu- ally receives this help from one or more family members who must make idrastic Changes in their own lives to provide it, and/or from paid personal care attendants (PCA). The relative or PCA assists with tasks such as bathing; dressing, bowel and bladder routines, household tasks, and transfer into and out of a wheelchair. In addition to these .essential tasks, which are usually performed in the morning and again at night, a high level quadriplegic may require help to perform